blob: 33cb53032095f42b777722832a096a65b1425288 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau02c7c142012-06-04 00:43:45 +02007 2012/06/04
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200455 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - noepoll
457 - nokqueue
458 - nopoll
459 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100460 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200461 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200463 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200464 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100465 - tune.maxaccept
466 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200467 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200468 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100469 - tune.rcvbuf.client
470 - tune.rcvbuf.server
471 - tune.sndbuf.client
472 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100473
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474 * Debugging
475 - debug
476 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477
478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004793.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200480------------------------------------
481
482chroot <jail dir>
483 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
484 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
485 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
486 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
487 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
488 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100489
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200490daemon
491 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
492 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
493 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
494
495gid <number>
496 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
497 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
498 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
499 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501group <group name>
502 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
503 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200505log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
507 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100508 configured with "log global".
509
510 <address> can be one of:
511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
514 port).
515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
518 port).
519
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100520 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
523 writeable).
524
525 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
528 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
529 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
530
531 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200532 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
533 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
534 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
535 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
536 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
537 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200539 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541log-send-hostname [<string>]
542 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
543 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
544 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
545 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
546 the logs.
547
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000548log-tag <string>
549 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
550 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
551 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
552 running on the same host.
553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554nbproc <number>
555 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
556 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
557 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
558 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
559 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
560
561pidfile <pidfile>
562 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
563 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
564 starting the process. See also "daemon".
565
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200566stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200567 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200568
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200569 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
570 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100571 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200572 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
573
574 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
575 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
576 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
577 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
578 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
579
580 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200581 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200582 counters).
583
584 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
585 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100586
587 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
588 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
589 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
590 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
591 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
592 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
593 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200594
595stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
596 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
597 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100598 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200599
600stats maxconn <connections>
601 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
602 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604uid <number>
605 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
606 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
607 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
608 one. See also "gid" and "user".
609
610ulimit-n <number>
611 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
612 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
613 option.
614
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100615unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
616 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
617
618 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
619 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
620 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
621 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
622 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
623 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
624 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
625 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
626 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
627 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200629user <user name>
630 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
631 See also "uid" and "group".
632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200633node <name>
634 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
635
636 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
637 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
638 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
639 traffic.
640
641description <text>
642 Add a text that describes the instance.
643
644 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
645 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
646 "<" and ">" characters.
647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006493.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650-----------------------
651
652maxconn <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
654 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
655 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
656 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
657
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200658maxconnrate <number>
659 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
660 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
661 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
662 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
663 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
664 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
665 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
666 fairness.
667
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100668maxpipes <number>
669 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
670 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
671 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
672 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
673 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
674 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
675
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200676maxsslconn <number>
677 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
678 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
679 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
680 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
681 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
682 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
683 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685noepoll
686 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
687 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
688 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
689
690nokqueue
691 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
692 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
693 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
694
695nopoll
696 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
697 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100698 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
700 "nokqueue".
701
702nosepoll
703 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
704 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
705 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
706
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100707nosplice
708 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
709 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
710 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100711 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100712 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
713 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
714 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
715 "option splice-response".
716
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200717spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
718 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
719 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
720 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
721 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
722 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
723
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200724tune.bufsize <number>
725 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
726 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
727 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
728 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
729 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
730 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
731 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
732 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
733
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200734tune.chksize <number>
735 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
736 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
737 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
738 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
739 checks whenever possible.
740
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200741tune.http.maxhdr <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
743 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
744 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
745 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
746 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
747 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
748 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
749 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
750 limit too high.
751
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100752tune.maxaccept <number>
753 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
754 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
755 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100756 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100757 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
758 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100759 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100760 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
761
762tune.maxpollevents <number>
763 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
764 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
765 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
766 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
767 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
768
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200769tune.maxrewrite <number>
770 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
771 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
772 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
773 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
774 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
775 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
776 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
777 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
778 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
779 bufsize.
780
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200781tune.pipesize <number>
782 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
783 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
784 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
785 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
786 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
787 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
788
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100789tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
790tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
792 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798
799tune.sndbuf.client <number>
800tune.sndbuf.server <number>
801 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
802 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
803 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
804 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
805 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
806 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
807 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
808 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
809 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
810 notifying haproxy again.
811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008133.3. Debugging
814--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815
816debug
817 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
818 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
819 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
820 system startup.
821
822quiet
823 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
824 line argument "-q".
825
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008273.4. Userlists
828--------------
829It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
830http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
831it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
832
833userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100834 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100835 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
836
837group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100838 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100839 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
840 proceeded by "users" keyword.
841
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
843 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100844 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
845 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100846 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
847 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100848 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
849 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
850
851
852 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100853 userlist L1
854 group G1 users tiger,scott
855 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100856
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100857 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
858 user scott insecure-password elgato
859 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100861 userlist L2
862 group G1
863 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100864
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100865 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
866 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
867 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100868
869 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200870
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200871
8723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200873----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200874It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
875haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
876pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
877identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
878or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
879Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
880known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
881the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
882process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
883during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
884tables.
885
886peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400887 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200888 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
889
890peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
891 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
892 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
893 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
894 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
895 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
896 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
897
898 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
899 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
900
901 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
902 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
903 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
904 across all peers.
905
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200906 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200907 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
909 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
910 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200911
912 backend mybackend
913 mode tcp
914 balance roundrobin
915 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
916 stick on src
917
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100918 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
919 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200920
921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009224. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
926 - defaults <name>
927 - frontend <name>
928 - backend <name>
929 - listen <name>
930
931A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
932its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
933section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935
936A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
937connections.
938
939A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
940to forward incoming connections.
941
942A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
943parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
946'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
947case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
948
949Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
950logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
951proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
952However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
953name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
954
955Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
956and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100957bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100958protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
959modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
960arbitrary criteria.
961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
964--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200966The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
967limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
968they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
969limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100970marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200971option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200972and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
973with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
974specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100977 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
978------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
979acl - X X X
980appsession - - X X
981backlog X X X -
982balance X - X X
983bind - X X -
984bind-process X X X X
985block - X X X
986capture cookie - X X -
987capture request header - X X -
988capture response header - X X -
989clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
990contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
991cookie X - X X
992default-server X - X X
993default_backend X X X -
994description - X X X
995disabled X X X X
996dispatch - - X X
997enabled X X X X
998errorfile X X X X
999errorloc X X X X
1000errorloc302 X X X X
1001-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1002errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001003force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004fullconn X - X X
1005grace X X X X
1006hash-type X - X X
1007http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001008http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001009http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001010http-request - X X X
1011id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001012ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001013log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001014maxconn X X X -
1015mode X X X X
1016monitor fail - X X -
1017monitor-net X X X -
1018monitor-uri X X X -
1019option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1020option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1021option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1022option allbackups (*) X - X X
1023option checkcache (*) X - X X
1024option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1025option contstats (*) X X X -
1026option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1027option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1028option forceclose (*) X X X X
1029-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1030option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001031option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001032option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001033option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1034option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1035option httpchk X - X X
1036option httpclose (*) X X X X
1037option httplog X X X X
1038option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001039option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001040option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1042option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1043option logasap (*) X X X -
1044option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001045option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001046option nolinger (*) X X X X
1047option originalto X X X X
1048option persist (*) X - X X
1049option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001050option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001051option smtpchk X - X X
1052option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1053option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1054option splice-request (*) X X X X
1055option splice-response (*) X X X X
1056option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1057option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1058-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1059option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1060option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1061option tcpka X X X X
1062option tcplog X X X X
1063option transparent (*) X - X X
1064persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1065rate-limit sessions X X X -
1066redirect - X X X
1067redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1068redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1069reqadd - X X X
1070reqallow - X X X
1071reqdel - X X X
1072reqdeny - X X X
1073reqiallow - X X X
1074reqidel - X X X
1075reqideny - X X X
1076reqipass - X X X
1077reqirep - X X X
1078reqisetbe - X X X
1079reqitarpit - X X X
1080reqpass - X X X
1081reqrep - X X X
1082-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1083reqsetbe - X X X
1084reqtarpit - X X X
1085retries X - X X
1086rspadd - X X X
1087rspdel - X X X
1088rspdeny - X X X
1089rspidel - X X X
1090rspideny - X X X
1091rspirep - X X X
1092rsprep - X X X
1093server - - X X
1094source X - X X
1095srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001096stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001097stats auth X - X X
1098stats enable X - X X
1099stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001100stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001101stats realm X - X X
1102stats refresh X - X X
1103stats scope X - X X
1104stats show-desc X - X X
1105stats show-legends X - X X
1106stats show-node X - X X
1107stats uri X - X X
1108-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1109stick match - - X X
1110stick on - - X X
1111stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001112stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001113stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001114tcp-request connection - X X -
1115tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001116tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001117tcp-response content - - X X
1118tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001119timeout check X - X X
1120timeout client X X X -
1121timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1122timeout connect X - X X
1123timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1124timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1125timeout http-request X X X X
1126timeout queue X - X X
1127timeout server X - X X
1128timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1129timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001130timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001131transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001132unique-id-format X X X -
1133unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001135use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001136------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1137 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011404.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1141---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001142
1143This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1144
1145
1146acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1147 Declare or complete an access list.
1148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1149 no | yes | yes | yes
1150 Example:
1151 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1152 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1153 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001155 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001156
1157
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001158appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1159 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1162 no | no | yes | yes
1163 Arguments :
1164 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1165 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1166
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001167 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168 checked in each cookie value.
1169
1170 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1171 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1172 milliseconds.
1173
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001174 request-learn
1175 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1176 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1177 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1178 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1179 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1180 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1181
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001182 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1183 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1184 data following this prefix.
1185
1186 Example :
1187 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1188
1189 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1190 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1191
1192 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1193 2 modes are currently supported :
1194 - path-parameters :
1195 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1196 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1197 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1198 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1199 - query-string :
1200 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1201 query string.
1202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1204 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1205 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1206 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001207 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1208 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1209 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1211 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1212
1213 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1214
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001215 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1216 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1217 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001219 Example :
1220 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1221
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001222 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1223 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001224
1225
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001226backlog <conns>
1227 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1229 yes | yes | yes | no
1230 Arguments :
1231 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1232 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001233 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001234
1235 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1236 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1237 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1238 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1239 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1240 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1241 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1242 backlog parameter.
1243
1244 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1245 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1246 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1247
1248 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1249
1250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001251balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001252balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001253 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1255 yes | no | yes | yes
1256 Arguments :
1257 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1258 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1259 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1260 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1261
1262 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1263 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1264 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1265 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001266 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1267 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1268 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1269 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1270 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1271 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1272 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1273 it, so that you don't worry.
1274
1275 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1276 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1277 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1278 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1279 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1280 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1281 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1282 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001283
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001284 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1285 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1286 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1287 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1288 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1289 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1290 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1291 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1292
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001293 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1294 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1295 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1296 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001297 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001298 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1299 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1300 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1301 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1302 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001303 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1304 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1305 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1306 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1307 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1308 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1311 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1312 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1313 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1314 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1315 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1316 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1317 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001318 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001320 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1321 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1322 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001324 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1325 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1326 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1327 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1328 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1329 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1330 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1331 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1332 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1333 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1334 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1335 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001336
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001337 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001338 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1339 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1340 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1341 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1342 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1343 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1344 URIs start with a leading "/".
1345
1346 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1347 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1348 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1349 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001351 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001352 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1353
1354 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001355 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1356 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1357 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1358 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1359 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1360 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1361 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1362 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1363 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1364 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1365 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1366 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1367 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1368 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1369 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1370 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1371 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1372 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1373 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001374
1375 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1376 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1377 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1378 server will receive the request.
1379
1380 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1381 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1382 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1383 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1384 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001385 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1386 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1387 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001389 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1390 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1391 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1392 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1393 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001395 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001396 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1397 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1398 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1399
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001400 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1401 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1402 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1403
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001404 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001405 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001406 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1407 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1408 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1409 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1410 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1411 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001412 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001413 used instead.
1414
1415 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1416 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1417 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1418 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1419
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001420 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1421 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1422 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1423
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001424 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001427 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1428 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001429
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001430 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001431 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001432
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001433 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1434 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1435 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001436
1437 Examples :
1438 balance roundrobin
1439 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001440 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001441 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1442 balance hdr(host)
1443 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001444
1445 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1446 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001448 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001449 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1450 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1451 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1452 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1453
1454 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1455 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1456 defaults to 16 kB.
1457
1458 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1459 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1460
1461 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1462 Round Robin.
1463
1464 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1465 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1466 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1467 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1468
1469 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1470
1471 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001472 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001473 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1474 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1475 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001477 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1478 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001481bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1482bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1483bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001484bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] backlog <backlog>
1485bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreau50acaaa2012-09-06 14:26:36 +02001486bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] nice <nice>
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001487bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1488bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1489bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1490bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001491bind /<path> [, ...]
1492bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1493bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1494bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1497 no | yes | yes | no
1498 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001499 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1500 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1501 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1502 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001503 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001504
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001505 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1506 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001507 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1508 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1509 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001510 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1511 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1512 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1513 the range.
1514
1515 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1516 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1517 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1518 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1519 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1520 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1521 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001522 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001523 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001524
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001525 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1526 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1527 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1528 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1529 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1530 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1531 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1532 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1533
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001534 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1535 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1536 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1537 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1538 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1539 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1540 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1541 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001542 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1543 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001544
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001545 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1546 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1547 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1548 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001549 kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux
1550 but was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may
1551 not work on other operating systems. It may also not change
1552 the advertised value but change the effective size of
1553 outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet
1554 networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
1555 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is
1556 negative, it will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming
1557 connection's advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This
1558 parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001559
Willy Tarreau32368ce2012-09-06 11:10:55 +02001560 <backlog> sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the
1561 frontend's backlog is used instead.
1562
1563 <maxconn> limits the socket to this number of concurrent connections.
1564 Extra connections will remain in the system's backlog until a
1565 connection is released. If unspecified, the limit will be the
1566 same as the frontend's maxconn. Note that in case of port
1567 ranges, the same value will be applied to each socket. This
1568 setting enables different limitations on expensive sockets,
1569 for instance SSL entries which may easily eat all memory.
1570
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001571 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1572 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1573 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1574 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001575
Willy Tarreau50acaaa2012-09-06 14:26:36 +02001576 <nice> sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket.
1577 Value must be in the range -1024..1024, and default is zero.
1578 Positive values means that such connections are more friendly
1579 to others and easily offer their place in the scheduler. On
1580 the opposite, negative values mean that connections want to
1581 run with a higher priority. The difference only happens under
1582 high loads when the system is close to saturation. Negative
1583 values are appropriate for low-latency or admin services, and
1584 high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks
1585 such as SSL processing which are less sensible to latency.
1586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001587 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1588
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001589 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1590 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1591 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1592 simply ignore this.
1593
1594 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1595 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1596 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1597 simply ignore this.
1598
1599 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1600 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1601 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1602 this.
1603
1604 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1605 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1606 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1607 this.
1608
1609 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1610 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1611 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1612 this.
1613
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001614 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1615 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1616 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001617 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001618 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1619 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1620 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1621 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001622 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1623 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001625 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001626 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1627 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1628 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1629 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1630 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1631 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1632 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1633 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1634 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1635 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1636 with front firewalls which would see an established
1637 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1638
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001639 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1640 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1641 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1642 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1643 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1644 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1645 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1646 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1647 This keyword combined with support from external components
1648 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1649 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1650 not even always usable.
1651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001652 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1653 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1654 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1655 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1656 in a frontend.
1657
1658 Example :
1659 listen http_proxy
1660 bind :80,:443
1661 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001662 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001664 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001665 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001666
1667
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001668bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1669 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1671 yes | yes | yes | yes
1672 Arguments :
1673 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1674 may be used to override a default value.
1675
1676 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1677 option may be combined with other numbers.
1678
1679 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1680 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1681 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1682 missing from all processes.
1683
1684 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1685 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1686 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1687 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1688
1689 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1690 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1691 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1692 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1693 and 'even' instances.
1694
1695 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1696 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1697 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1698 32.
1699
1700 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1701 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1702
1703 Example :
1704 listen app_ip1
1705 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001706 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001707
1708 listen app_ip2
1709 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001710 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001711
1712 listen management
1713 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001714 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001715
1716 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1717
1718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719block { if | unless } <condition>
1720 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1722 no | yes | yes | yes
1723
1724 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1725 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001726 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001727 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001728 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1729 "block" statements per instance.
1730
1731 Example:
1732 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1733 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1734 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1735 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001737 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738
1739
1740capture cookie <name> len <length>
1741 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1743 no | yes | yes | no
1744 Arguments :
1745 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1746 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1747 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1748 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1749 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1750
1751 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1752 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1753 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1754 right if it exceeds <length>.
1755
1756 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1757 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1758 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1759 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1760
1761 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1762 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1763 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1764
1765 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1766 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1767 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1768 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001769 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1771
1772 Example:
1773 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1774
1775 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001776 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001777
1778
1779capture request header <name> len <length>
1780 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1782 no | yes | yes | no
1783 Arguments :
1784 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001785 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1787 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1788 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1789
1790 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1791 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1792 it exceeds <length>.
1793
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001794 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1796 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001797 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1798 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1799 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1800 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001801 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001802 environments to find where the request came from.
1803
1804 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1805 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1806 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1807 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001808
1809 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1810 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1811 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1812 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1813
1814 Example:
1815 capture request header Host len 15
1816 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1817 capture request header Referrer len 15
1818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001820 about logging.
1821
1822
1823capture response header <name> len <length>
1824 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1826 no | yes | yes | no
1827 Arguments :
1828 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001829 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1831 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1832 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1833
1834 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1835 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1836 it exceeds <length>.
1837
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001838 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1840 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1841 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001842 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1843 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1844 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1845 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846
1847 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1848 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1849 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1850 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1851
1852 Example:
1853 capture response header Content-length len 9
1854 capture response header Location len 15
1855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001856 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857 about logging.
1858
1859
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001860clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1863 yes | yes | yes | no
1864 Arguments :
1865 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1867 as explained at the top of this document.
1868
1869 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1870 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1871 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1872 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1873 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1874 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1875 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1876 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001877 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1879 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1880
1881 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1882 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1883 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1884 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1885 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1886 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1887
1888 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1889 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1890
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001891 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1892 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001893
1894
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001895contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1898 yes | no | yes | yes
1899 Arguments :
1900 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1902 as explained at the top of this document.
1903
1904 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001905 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001906 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1908 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1909 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1910 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1911
1912 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1913 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1914 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1915 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1916 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1917 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1918
1919 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1920 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1921 instead.
1922
1923 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1924 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1925
1926
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001927cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001928 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1929 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001930 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1932 yes | no | yes | yes
1933 Arguments :
1934 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1935 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1936 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1937 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1938 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1939 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1940 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1941 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1942 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1943
1944 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1945 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1946 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1947 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1948 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1949 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1950 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1951 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1952 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1953 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1954 "insert" and "prefix".
1955
1956 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001957 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001958
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001959 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001960 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1961 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1962 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1963 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1964 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1965 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1966 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1967 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1968 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1969 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970
1971 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1972 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1973 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1974 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1975 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1976 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1977 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1978 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1979 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1980 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001981 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1982 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1983 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001985 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1986 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1987 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001988 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1989 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1990 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1991 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001992 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1993 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1994 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001995
1996 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1997 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1998 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1999 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2000 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2001 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2002 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2003 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2004 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2005
2006 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2007 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2008 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2009 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2010 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2011 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2012 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2013 persistence cookie in the cache.
2014 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2015
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002016 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2017 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2018 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2019 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2020 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2021 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2022 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2023 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2024 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2025 they logout.
2026
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002027 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2028 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2029 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2030 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2031
2032 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2033 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2034 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2035 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2036 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2037 this attribute.
2038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002039 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002040 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002041 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2042 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2043 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2044 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2045 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2046 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002047
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002048 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2049 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2050 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2051 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2052 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2053 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2054 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2055 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2056 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2057 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2058 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2059 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2060 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2061 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2062 the site.
2063
2064 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2065 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2066 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2067 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2068 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2069 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2070 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2071 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2072 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2073 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2074 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2075 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2076 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2077 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2078 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2079 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2082 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2083 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2084 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 Examples :
2087 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2088 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2089 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002090 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002092 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002093 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002096default-server [param*]
2097 Change default options for a server in a backend
2098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2099 yes | no | yes | yes
2100 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002101 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2102 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2103 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2104 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002105
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002106 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002107 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2108
2109 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002111
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002112default_backend <backend>
2113 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2115 yes | yes | yes | no
2116 Arguments :
2117 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2118
2119 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2120 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2121 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2122 will catch all undetermined requests.
2123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124 Example :
2125
2126 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2127 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2128 default_backend dynamic
2129
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002130 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2131
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002132
2133disabled
2134 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2136 yes | yes | yes | yes
2137 Arguments : none
2138
2139 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2140 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2141 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2142 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2143 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2144 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2145 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2146
2147 See also : "enabled"
2148
2149
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002150dispatch <address>:<port>
2151 Set a default server address
2152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2153 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002154 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002155
2156 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2157 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2158 during start-up.
2159
2160 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2161 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2162 possible with normal servers.
2163
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002164 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002165 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2166 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2167 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2168 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2169
2170 See also : "server"
2171
2172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173enabled
2174 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2176 yes | yes | yes | yes
2177 Arguments : none
2178
2179 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2180 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2181
2182 See also : "disabled"
2183
2184
2185errorfile <code> <file>
2186 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2188 yes | yes | yes | yes
2189 Arguments :
2190 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002191 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192
2193 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002194 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002196 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2197 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
2199 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2200 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2201 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2202
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002203 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2206 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2207 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2208 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2209
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002210 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2211 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2212 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2213 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2214 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2215 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2218 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2219 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002220 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2222
2223 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2224
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002225 Example :
2226 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2227 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2228 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2229
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002230
2231errorloc <code> <url>
2232errorloc302 <code> <url>
2233 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | yes | yes | yes
2236 Arguments :
2237 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002238 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002239
2240 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2241 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2242 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2243 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2244 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2245
2246 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2247 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2248 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2249
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002250 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2251
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002252 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2253 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2254 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2255 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2256 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2257 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2258 request.
2259
2260 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2261
2262
2263errorloc303 <code> <url>
2264 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2266 yes | yes | yes | yes
2267 Arguments :
2268 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2269 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2270
2271 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2272 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2273 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2274 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2275 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2276
2277 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2278 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2279 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2280
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002281 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2282
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002283 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2284 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2285 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2286 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002287 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002288
2289 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2290
2291
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002292force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2293 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2294 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2295 no | yes | yes | yes
2296
2297 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2298 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2299 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2300 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2301 marked down for maintenance operations.
2302
2303 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2304 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2305 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2306 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2307 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2308 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2309 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2310 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2311 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2312
2313 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2314 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2315 is used.
2316
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002317 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002318 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002319
2320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002321fullconn <conns>
2322 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2324 yes | no | yes | yes
2325 Arguments :
2326 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2327 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2328
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002329 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002330 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002331 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002332 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2333 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2334 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2335 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2336 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002337 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002338
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002339 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2340 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2341 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2342
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002343 Example :
2344 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2345 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2346 # connections.
2347 backend dynamic
2348 fullconn 10000
2349 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2350 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2351
2352 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2353
2354
2355grace <time>
2356 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002358 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002359 Arguments :
2360 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2361 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2362 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2363
2364 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2365 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002366 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002367 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2368
2369 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2370 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2371 simplify it.
2372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002374hash-type <method>
2375 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2377 yes | no | yes | yes
2378 Arguments :
2379 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2380 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2381 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2382 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2383 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2384 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2385 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2386 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2387 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2388
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002389 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2390 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2391 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2392 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2393 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2394 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2395 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2396 this value.
2397
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002398 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2399 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2400 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2401 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2402 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2403 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2404 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2405 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2406 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2407 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2408 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2409 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2410 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2411
2412 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2413
2414 See also : "balance", "server"
2415
2416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417http-check disable-on-404
2418 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002420 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421 Arguments : none
2422
2423 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2424 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2425 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2426 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2427 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2428 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2429 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2430 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002431 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2432 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2433 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2434
2435 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2436
2437
2438http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002439 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002441 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002442 Arguments :
2443 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2444 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002445 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002446 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2447 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2448 details on the supported keywords.
2449
2450 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2451 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2452 with the usual backslash ('\').
2453
2454 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2455 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2456 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2457 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2458 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2459
2460 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002461 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002462 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2463 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2464 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2465
2466 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002467 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002468 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2469 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2470 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2471 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2472
2473 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002474 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002475 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2476 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2477 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2478 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2479 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2480 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2481 trace).
2482
2483 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002484 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002485 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2486 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2487 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2488 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2489 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2490 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2491
2492 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2493 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2494 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2495 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2496 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2497 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2498 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2499 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2500
2501 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2502 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2503
2504 Examples :
2505 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002506 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002507
2508 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002509 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002510
2511 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002512 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002513
2514 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002515 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002517 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002518
2519
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002520http-check send-state
2521 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2523 yes | no | yes | yes
2524 Arguments : none
2525
2526 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2527 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2528 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2529 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2530 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2531
2532 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2533 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2534 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2535 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2536 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2537 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2538 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2539 checked in multiple backends.
2540
2541 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2542 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2543
2544 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2545 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2546 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2547 one fails.
2548
2549 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2550 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2551 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2552
2553 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2554 server's queue.
2555
2556 Example of a header received by the application server :
2557 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2558 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2559
2560 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2561
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002562http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002564 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2565
2566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2567 no | yes | yes | yes
2568
2569 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2570 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2571 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002572 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2573 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002574 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2575
2576 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2577 instance.
2578
2579 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002580 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2581 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2582 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002583
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002584 http-request allow if nagios
2585 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2586 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2587 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002588
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002589 Example:
2590 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002591
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002592 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002593
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002594 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2595 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002596
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002597http-send-name-header [<header>]
2598 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2599
2600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 yes | no | yes | yes
2602
2603 Arguments :
2604
2605 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2606
2607 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2608 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2609 is added with the header string proved.
2610
2611 See also : "server"
2612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002613id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002614 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 no | yes | yes | yes
2617 Arguments : none
2618
2619 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2620 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2621 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002622
2623
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002624ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2625 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 no | yes | yes | yes
2628
2629 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2630 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2631 and running).
2632
2633 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2634 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2635 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2636 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2637 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2638
2639 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2640 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2641
2642 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2643 "unless" condition is met.
2644
2645 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2646
2647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002649log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002650no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002651 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2653 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002654
2655 Prefix :
2656 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2657 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2658 prefix does not allow arguments.
2659
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002660 Arguments :
2661 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2662 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2663 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2664 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2665 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2666 parameter.
2667
2668 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2669 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2670
2671 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2672 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2673 standard syslog port).
2674
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002675 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2676 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2677 standard syslog port).
2678
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002679 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2680 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2681 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2682 appropriately writeable).
2683
2684 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2685
2686 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2687 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2688 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2689
2690 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2691 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2692 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002693 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2694 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2695 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2696 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2697 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002698
2699 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2700
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002701 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2702 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2703 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002704
2705 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2706 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2707 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2708 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2709
2710 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2711 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002712
2713 Example :
2714 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002715 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2716 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002717
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002718log-format <string>
2719 Allows you to custom a log line.
2720
2721 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2722
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002723
2724maxconn <conns>
2725 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2727 yes | yes | yes | no
2728 Arguments :
2729 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2730 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2731 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2732 closes.
2733
2734 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2735 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2736 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2737 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2738 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2739 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2740 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2741 properly tuned.
2742
2743 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2744 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2745 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2746
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002747 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002749 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2750
2751
2752mode { tcp|http|health }
2753 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2755 yes | yes | yes | yes
2756 Arguments :
2757 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2758 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2759 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2760 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2761
2762 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2763 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2764 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2765 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2766 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2767
2768 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2769 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2770 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2771 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2772 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2773 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2774
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002775 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2776 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2777 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002779 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002780 defaults http_instances
2781 mode http
2782
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002783 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002784
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002785
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002786monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2789 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790 Arguments :
2791 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2792 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002793 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2795 backend and its backup.
2796
2797 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2798 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2799 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2800 servers in a list of backends.
2801
2802 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2803 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2804 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2805 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2806 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2807 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2808 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002809 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2810 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811
2812 Example:
2813 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002814 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2816 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2817 monitor-uri /site_alive
2818 monitor fail if site_dead
2819
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002820 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002821
2822
2823monitor-net <source>
2824 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2826 yes | yes | yes | no
2827 Arguments :
2828 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2829 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2830 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2831 followed by a mask.
2832
2833 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2834 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002835 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002836 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2837
2838 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2839 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2840 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2841 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2842 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2843
2844 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2845 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2846 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2847 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2848 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2849
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002850 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2851 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002853 Example :
2854 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2855 frontend www
2856 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2857
2858 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2859
2860
2861monitor-uri <uri>
2862 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2864 yes | yes | yes | no
2865 Arguments :
2866 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2867 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2868
2869 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2870 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2871 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2872 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2873 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2874 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2875 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2876 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2877
2878 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2879 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2880 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2881 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2882 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2883 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2884
2885 Example :
2886 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2887 frontend www
2888 mode http
2889 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2890
2891 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002893
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002894option abortonclose
2895no option abortonclose
2896 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2898 yes | no | yes | yes
2899 Arguments : none
2900
2901 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2902 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2903 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2904 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002905 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002906 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2907 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2908 encountered while delivering the response.
2909
2910 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2911 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2912 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2913 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2914 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2915 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002916 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002917 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002918 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002919 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2920 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2921 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2922
2923 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2924 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2925 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2926 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2927 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2928 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2929 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2930 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002931 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002932
2933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2935
2936 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2937
2938
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002939option accept-invalid-http-request
2940no option accept-invalid-http-request
2941 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2943 yes | yes | yes | no
2944 Arguments : none
2945
2946 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2947 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2948 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2949 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2950 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2951 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2952 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2953 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002954 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2955 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2956 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2957 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2958 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2959 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002960
2961 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2962 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2963 been confirmed.
2964
2965 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2966 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002967 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2968 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002969 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2970
2971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2973
2974 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2975 stats socket.
2976
2977
2978option accept-invalid-http-response
2979no option accept-invalid-http-response
2980 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2982 yes | no | yes | yes
2983 Arguments : none
2984
2985 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2986 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2987 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2988 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2989 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2990 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2991 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2992 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2993 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2994
2995 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2996 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2997 been confirmed.
2998
2999 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3000 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3001 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3002 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3003
3004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3006
3007 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3008 stats socket.
3009
3010
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003011option allbackups
3012no option allbackups
3013 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3015 yes | no | yes | yes
3016 Arguments : none
3017
3018 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3019 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3020 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3021 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3022 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3023 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3024 order between the backup servers anymore.
3025
3026 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3027 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3028
3029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3031
3032
3033option checkcache
3034no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003035 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3037 yes | no | yes | yes
3038 Arguments : none
3039
3040 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3041 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003042 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003043 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3044 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003045 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003046
3047 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003048 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003049 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003050 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3051 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003052 to the client are :
3053 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003054 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003055 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003056 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3057 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3058 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3059 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3060 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3061 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3062 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3063 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3064 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3065 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3066 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3067
3068 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003069 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003070 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003071 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003072 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3073
3074 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3075 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003076 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003077 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3078
3079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3081
3082
3083option clitcpka
3084no option clitcpka
3085 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 yes | yes | yes | no
3088 Arguments : none
3089
3090 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3091 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3092 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3093 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3094
3095 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3096 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3097 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3098 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3099
3100 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3101 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3102 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3103 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3104 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3105
3106 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3107
3108 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3109 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3110 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3111
3112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3114
3115 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3116
3117
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118option contstats
3119 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 yes | yes | yes | no
3122 Arguments : none
3123
3124 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3125 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3126 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3127 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3128 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3129 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3130 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3131
3132
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003133option dontlog-normal
3134no option dontlog-normal
3135 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3137 yes | yes | yes | no
3138 Arguments : none
3139
3140 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3141 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3142 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3143 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3144 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3145 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3146 logged.
3147
3148 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3149 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3150 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003152 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003153 logging.
3154
3155
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003156option dontlognull
3157no option dontlognull
3158 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | yes | yes | no
3161 Arguments : none
3162
3163 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3164 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3165 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3166 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3167 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3168 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3169 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3170
3171 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3172 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3173 would not be logged.
3174
3175 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3176 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003178 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003179
3180
3181option forceclose
3182no option forceclose
3183 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003185 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003186 Arguments : none
3187
3188 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3189 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3190 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3191 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3192 global session times in the logs.
3193
3194 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003195 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003196 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3197 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3198 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3199 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003200
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003201 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3202 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3203 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3204
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3207
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003208 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003209
3210
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003211option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003212 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3214 yes | yes | yes | yes
3215 Arguments :
3216 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3217 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003218 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003219 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003220
3221 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3222 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3223 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3224 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3225 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3226 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3227 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003228 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3229 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3230 possible that the client has already brought one.
3231
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003232 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003233 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003234 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3235 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003236 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3237 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003238
3239 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3240 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3241 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3242 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3243 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3244 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3245 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3246
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003247 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3248 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3249 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3250 are under the control of the end-user.
3251
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003252 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003253 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3254 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003255 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3256 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3257 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003258
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003259 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3260 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3261 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3262 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3263 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003264
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003265 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003266 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3267 frontend www
3268 mode http
3269 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3270
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003271 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3272 backend www
3273 mode http
3274 option forwardfor header X-Client
3275
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003276 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3277 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003278
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003279
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003280option http-no-delay
3281no option http-no-delay
3282 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3284 yes | yes | yes | yes
3285 Arguments : none
3286
3287 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3288 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3289 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3290 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3291 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3292 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3293 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3294 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3295 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3296 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3297 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3298 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3299 affected.
3300
3301 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3302 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3303 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3304 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3305 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3306 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3307 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3308 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3309 latency environments.
3310
3311
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003312option http-pretend-keepalive
3313no option http-pretend-keepalive
3314 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3316 yes | yes | yes | yes
3317 Arguments : none
3318
3319 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3320 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3321 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3322 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3323 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3324 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3325 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3326 consider the response complete.
3327
3328 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3329 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3330 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3331 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3332 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3333 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3334
3335 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3336 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3337 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3338 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3339 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3340 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3341 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3342
3343 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3344 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003345 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003346 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3347 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003348
3349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3351
3352 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3353
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003354
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003355option http-server-close
3356no option http-server-close
3357 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3359 yes | yes | yes | yes
3360 Arguments : none
3361
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003362 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3363 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3364 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3365 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3366 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3367 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3368 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3369 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3370 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3371 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3372 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3373 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003374
3375 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3376 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3377 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3378 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003379 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3380 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003381
3382 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3383 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003384 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3385 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3386 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003387
3388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3390
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003391 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3392 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003393
3394
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003395option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003396no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003397 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | no
3400 Arguments : none
3401
3402 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3403 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3404 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3405 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3406 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3407 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3408 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3409
3410 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3411 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3412 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3413 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3414 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3415 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3416 request along its whole life.
3417
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003418 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3419 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3420 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3421 front of an existing proxy.
3422
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003423 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3424
3425 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3426 http-server-close".
3427
3428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003429option httpchk
3430option httpchk <uri>
3431option httpchk <method> <uri>
3432option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3433 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3435 yes | no | yes | yes
3436 Arguments :
3437 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3438 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3439 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3440 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3441 ones.
3442
3443 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3444 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3445 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3446
3447 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3448 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3449 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3450 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3451 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3452
3453 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3454 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3455 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3456 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3457 the lack of any response.
3458
3459 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3460
3461 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3462 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3463 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3464
3465 Examples :
3466 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3467 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3468 backend https_relay
3469 mode tcp
3470 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3471 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3472
3473 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003474 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3475 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003476
3477
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003478option httpclose
3479no option httpclose
3480 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 yes | yes | yes | yes
3483 Arguments : none
3484
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003485 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3486 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3487 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3488 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3489 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3490 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3491 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003492
3493 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003494 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003495 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3496 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3497 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3498 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3499 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003500
3501 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3502 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3503 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003504 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3505 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003506
3507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3509
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003510 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3511 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003512
3513
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003514option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003515 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3517 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003518 Arguments :
3519 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3520 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3521 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3522 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3523 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003524
3525 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3526 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3527 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3528 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3529 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3530 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3531 ports.
3532
3533 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3534
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3537 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3538 by default.
3539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003540 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003541
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003542
3543option http_proxy
3544no option http_proxy
3545 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3547 yes | yes | yes | yes
3548 Arguments : none
3549
3550 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3551 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3552 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3553 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3554 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3555
3556 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3557 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3558 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3559 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003560 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003561 be analyzed.
3562
3563 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3564 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3565
3566 Example :
3567 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3568 backend direct_forward
3569 option httpclose
3570 option http_proxy
3571
3572 See also : "option httpclose"
3573
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003574
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003575option independent-streams
3576no option independent-streams
3577 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | yes | yes | yes
3580 Arguments : none
3581
3582 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3583 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3584 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3585 receive data or not.
3586
3587 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3588 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3589 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3590 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3591 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3592 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3593 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3594 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3595 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3596 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3597 socket buffers.
3598
3599 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3600 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3601 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3602 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3603 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3604
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003605 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3606 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3607 deprecated.
3608
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003609 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003610
3611
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003612option ldap-check
3613 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3615 yes | no | yes | yes
3616 Arguments : none
3617
3618 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3619 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3620 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3621 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3622
3623 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3624 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3625
3626 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3627 configure it.
3628
3629 Example :
3630 option ldap-check
3631
3632 See also : "option httpchk"
3633
3634
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003635option log-health-checks
3636no option log-health-checks
3637 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3639 yes | no | yes | yes
3640 Arguments : none
3641
3642 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3643 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3644 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3645 of additional information is limited.
3646
3647 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3648 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3649
3650 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3651
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003652
3653option log-separate-errors
3654no option log-separate-errors
3655 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | yes | yes | no
3658 Arguments : none
3659
3660 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3661 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3662 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3663 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3664 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3665 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3666 provides very important information.
3667
3668 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3669 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3670 error logs.
3671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003672 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003673 logging.
3674
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003675
3676option logasap
3677no option logasap
3678 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3680 yes | yes | yes | no
3681 Arguments : none
3682
3683 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3684 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3685 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3686 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3687 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3688 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3689 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003690 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003691 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3692 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3693
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003694 Examples :
3695 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3696 mode http
3697 option httplog
3698 option logasap
3699 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3700
3701 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3702 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3703 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3704 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003706 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003707 logging.
3708
3709
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003710option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3711 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003714 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003715 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3716 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003717
3718 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3719 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3720 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3721 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3722 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3723 in the MySQL table, like this :
3724
3725 USE mysql;
3726 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3727 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3728
3729 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3730 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3731 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3732 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3733 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3734 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3735 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3736 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3737 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3738
3739 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3740 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003741
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003742 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003743
3744 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3745 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3746 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3747 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3748 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3749 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3750
3751 See also: "option httpchk"
3752
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003753option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3754 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | no | yes | yes
3757 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003758 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3759 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003760
3761 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3762 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3763 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3764 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3765
3766 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003767
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003768option nolinger
3769no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003770 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3772 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003773 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003774
3775 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3776 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3777 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3778 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3779 connections.
3780
3781 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3782 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3783 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3784 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3785 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3786 this too.
3787
3788 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3789 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3790 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3791
3792 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3793 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3794 for servers.
3795
3796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3798
3799
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003800option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3801 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3803 yes | yes | yes | yes
3804 Arguments :
3805 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3806 matching <network>
3807 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3808 header name.
3809
3810 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3811 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3812 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3813 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3814 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3815 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3816 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3817 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3818 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3819 possible that the client has already brought one.
3820
3821 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3822 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3823 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3824 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3825 header and requires different one.
3826
3827 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3828 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3829 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3830 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3831 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3832 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3833 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3834
3835 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3836 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3837 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3838 both are defined.
3839
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003840 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3841 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3842 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3843 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3844 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003845
3846 Examples :
3847 # Original Destination address
3848 frontend www
3849 mode http
3850 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3851
3852 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3853 backend www
3854 mode http
3855 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3856
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003857 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3858 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003859
3860
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003861option persist
3862no option persist
3863 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3865 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003866 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003867
3868 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3869 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3870 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3871 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3872 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3873 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3874 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3875 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3876 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3877 redirected to another valid server.
3878
3879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3881
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003882 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003883
3884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003885option redispatch
3886no option redispatch
3887 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3889 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003890 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003891
3892 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3893 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3894 be able to access the service anymore.
3895
3896 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3897 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3898
3899 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3900 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3901 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003903 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3904 "redisp" keywords.
3905
3906 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3907 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3908
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003909 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003910
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003911
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003912option redis-check
3913 Use redis health checks for server testing
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3915 yes | no | yes | yes
3916 Arguments : none
3917
3918 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3919 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3920 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3921 find the "+PONG" response message.
3922
3923 Example :
3924 option redis-check
3925
3926 See also : "option httpchk"
3927
3928
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003929option smtpchk
3930option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3931 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3933 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003934 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003935 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3936 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3937 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3938
3939 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3940 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3941 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3942
3943 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3944 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3945 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3946 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3947 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3948 dead server.
3949
3950 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3951 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3952 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3953 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3954
3955 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3956 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3957 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3958 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3959 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3960
3961 Example :
3962 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3963
3964 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003967option socket-stats
3968no option socket-stats
3969
3970 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3972 yes | yes | yes | no
3973
3974 Arguments : none
3975
3976
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003977option splice-auto
3978no option splice-auto
3979 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3981 yes | yes | yes | yes
3982 Arguments : none
3983
3984 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3985 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3986 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3987 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003988 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003989 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3990 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3991 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3992 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3993
3994 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3995 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3996 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3997 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3998 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3999 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4000 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4001 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4002 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4003 keyword.
4004
4005 Example :
4006 option splice-auto
4007
4008 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4009 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4010
4011 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4012 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4013
4014
4015option splice-request
4016no option splice-request
4017 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4019 yes | yes | yes | yes
4020 Arguments : none
4021
4022 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004023 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004024 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4025 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4026 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4027 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4028
4029 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4030
4031 Example :
4032 option splice-request
4033
4034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4036
4037 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4038 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4039
4040
4041option splice-response
4042no option splice-response
4043 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments : none
4047
4048 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004049 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004050 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4051 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4052 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4053 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4054
4055 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4056
4057 Example :
4058 option splice-response
4059
4060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4062
4063 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4064 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4065
4066
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004067option srvtcpka
4068no option srvtcpka
4069 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | no | yes | yes
4072 Arguments : none
4073
4074 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4075 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4076 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4077 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4078
4079 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4080 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4081 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4082 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4083
4084 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4085 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4086 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4087 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4088 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4089
4090 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4091
4092 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4093 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4094 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4095
4096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4098
4099 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4100
4101
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004102option ssl-hello-chk
4103 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | no | yes | yes
4106 Arguments : none
4107
4108 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4109 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4110 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4111 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4112 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4113 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4114 hello message.
4115
4116 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4117 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4118 messages, which is appreciable.
4119
4120 See also: "option httpchk"
4121
4122
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004123option tcp-smart-accept
4124no option tcp-smart-accept
4125 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4127 yes | yes | yes | no
4128 Arguments : none
4129
4130 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4131 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4132 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4133 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4134 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4135 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4136
4137 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4138 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4139 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4140 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4141
4142 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4143 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4144 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4145 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4146
4147 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4148 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4149 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4150
4151 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4152 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4153 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4154
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004155 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4156
4157
4158option tcp-smart-connect
4159no option tcp-smart-connect
4160 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4162 yes | no | yes | yes
4163 Arguments : none
4164
4165 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4166 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4167 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4168 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4169 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4170
4171 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4172 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4173 complex.
4174
4175 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4176 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4177 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4178
4179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4181
4182 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4183
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004184
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004185option tcpka
4186 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4188 yes | yes | yes | yes
4189 Arguments : none
4190
4191 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4192 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4193 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4194 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4195
4196 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4197 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4198 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4199 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4200
4201 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4202 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4203 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4204 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4205 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4206
4207 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4208
4209 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4210 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4211 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4212 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4213 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4214 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4215 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4216 backends.
4217
4218 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4219
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004220
4221option tcplog
4222 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | yes | yes | yes
4225 Arguments : none
4226
4227 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4228 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4229 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4230 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4231 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4232 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4233 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4234 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4235
4236 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004238 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004239
4240
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004241option transparent
4242no option transparent
4243 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004245 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004246 Arguments : none
4247
4248 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4249 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4250 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4251 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4252 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4253 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4254 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4255 appropriate server.
4256
4257 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4258 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4259
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004260 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004261 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004262
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004263
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004264persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004265persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004266 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | no | yes | yes
4269 Arguments :
4270 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004271 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4272 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004273
4274 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4275 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4276 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4277 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4278 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4279 forwarded to this server.
4280
4281 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4282 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4283 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004284 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004285 a single "listen" section.
4286
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004287 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4288 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4289 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4290
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004291 Example :
4292 listen tse-farm
4293 bind :3389
4294 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4295 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4296 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4297 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4298 persist rdp-cookie
4299 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004300 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004301 balance rdp-cookie
4302 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4303 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4304
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004305 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4306 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004307
4308
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004309rate-limit sessions <rate>
4310 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4312 yes | yes | yes | no
4313 Arguments :
4314 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4315 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4316
4317 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4318 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4319 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4320 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4321 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4322 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4323
4324 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4325 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4326 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4327 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4328
4329 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4330 listen smtp
4331 mode tcp
4332 bind :25
4333 rate-limit sessions 10
4334 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4335
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004336 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4337 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4338 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004339
4340 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4341
4342
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004343redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4344redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004345 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4347 no | yes | yes | yes
4348
4349 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004350 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004351
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004352 Arguments :
4353 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4354 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4355 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4356 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004357 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4358 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4359 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4360 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004361
4362 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4363 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4364 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4365 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4366 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4367 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4368 location with a GET method.
4369
4370 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4371 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4372
4373 - "drop-query"
4374 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4375 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4376 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4377 with a location-type redirect.
4378
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004379 - "append-slash"
4380 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4381 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4382 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4383 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4384
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004385 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4386 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4387 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4388 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4389 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4390 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4391 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4392
4393 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4394 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4395 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4396 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4397 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4398 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4399 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004400
4401 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4402 acl clear dst_port 80
4403 acl secure dst_port 8080
4404 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004405 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004406 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004407 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4408
4409 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004410 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4411 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4412 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004413 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004414
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004415 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4416 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4417 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004419 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004420
4421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004422redisp (deprecated)
4423redispatch (deprecated)
4424 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4426 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004427 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004428
4429 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4430 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4431 be able to access the service anymore.
4432
4433 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4434 redistribute them to a working server.
4435
4436 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4437 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4438 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004440 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4441 "option redispatch" instead.
4442
4443 See also : "option redispatch"
4444
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004445
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004446reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004447 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 no | yes | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
4451 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4452 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004453 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004454
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004455 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4456 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4457
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004458 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4459 the last header of an HTTP request.
4460
4461 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4462 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4463 responses.
4464
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004465 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4466 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4467 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4468
4469 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4470 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004471
4472
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004473reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4474reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004475 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4477 no | yes | yes | yes
4478 Arguments :
4479 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4480 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4481 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4482 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4483 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4484 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4485 ignores case.
4486
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004487 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4488 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4489
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004490 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4491 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4492 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4493 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004494 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004495
4496 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4497 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4498
4499 Example :
4500 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4501 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4502 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004504 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4505 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004506
4507
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004508reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4509reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004510 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4512 no | yes | yes | yes
4513 Arguments :
4514 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4515 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4516 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4517 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4518 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4519 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4520
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004521 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4522 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4523
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004524 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4525 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4526 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4527 next servers.
4528
4529 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4530 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4531 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4532
4533 Example :
4534 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4535 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4536 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4537
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004538 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4539 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004540
4541
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004542reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4543reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004544 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4546 no | yes | yes | yes
4547 Arguments :
4548 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4549 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4550 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4551 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4552 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4553 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4554 case.
4555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004556 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4557 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4558
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004559 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4560 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4561 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4562 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004563 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004564
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004565 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004566 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004567 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004568
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4570 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4571
4572 Example :
4573 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4574 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4575 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4576
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004577 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4578 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004579
4580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004581reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4582reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 no | yes | yes | yes
4586 Arguments :
4587 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4588 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4589 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4590 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4591 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4592 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4593 case.
4594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004598 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4599 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4600 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4601 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4602
4603 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4604 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4605
4606 Example :
4607 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4608 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4609 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4610 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4611
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004612 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4613 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004614
4615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004616reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4617reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004618 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 no | yes | yes | yes
4621 Arguments :
4622 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4623 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4624 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4625 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4626 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4627 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4628
4629 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4630 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4631 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4632 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004633 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004634
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004635 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4636 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4637
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004638 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4639 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4640 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4641
4642 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4643 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4644 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4645 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4646 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4647
4648 Example :
4649 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004650 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004651 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4652 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4653
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004654 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4655 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004656
4657
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004658reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4659reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004660 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4662 no | yes | yes | yes
4663 Arguments :
4664 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4665 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4666 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4667 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4668 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4669 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4670 ignores case.
4671
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004672 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4673 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4674
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004675 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4676 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004677 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4678 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4679 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004680 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4681 not set.
4682
4683 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4684 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4685 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4686 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4687 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4688
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004689 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004690 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4691 # block all others.
4692 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4693 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004695 # block bad guys
4696 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4697 reqitarpit . if badguys
4698
4699 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4700 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004701
4702
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004703retries <value>
4704 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | no | yes | yes
4707 Arguments :
4708 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4709 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4710 default value is 3.
4711
4712 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4713 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4714 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4715
4716 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4717 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4718
4719 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4720 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4721
4722 See also : "option redispatch"
4723
4724
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004725rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004726 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 no | yes | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4731 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004732 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004733
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004734 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4735 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4736
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004737 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4738 the last header of an HTTP response.
4739
4740 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4741 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4742 responses.
4743
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004744 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4745 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004746
4747
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004748rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4749rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004750 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 no | yes | yes | yes
4753 Arguments :
4754 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4755 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4756 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4757 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4758 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4759 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4760 ignores case.
4761
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004762 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4763 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4764
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004765 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4766 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004767 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004768 client.
4769
4770 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4771 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4772 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4773
4774 Example :
4775 # remove the Server header from responses
4776 reqidel ^Server:.*
4777
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004778 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4779 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004780
4781
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004782rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4783rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004784 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 no | yes | yes | yes
4787 Arguments :
4788 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4789 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4790 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4791 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4792 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4793 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4794 ignores case.
4795
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004796 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4797 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4798
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004799 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4800 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4801 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4802 case-sensitive.
4803
4804 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004805 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4806 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4807 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004808
4809 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4810 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4811
4812 Example :
4813 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4814 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4815
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004816 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4817 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004818
4819
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004820rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4821rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004822 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 no | yes | yes | yes
4825 Arguments :
4826 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4827 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4828 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4829 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4830 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4831 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4832 ignores case.
4833
4834 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4835 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4836 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4837 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004838 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004839
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004840 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4841 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4842
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004843 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4844 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4845 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4846
4847 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4848 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4849 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4850 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4851 are not case-sensitive.
4852
4853 Example :
4854 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4855 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4856
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004857 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4858 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004859
4860
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004861server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004862 Declare a server in a backend
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 no | no | yes | yes
4865 Arguments :
4866 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004867 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4868 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004869
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004870 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4871 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4872 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4873 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004874 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4875 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4876 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4877 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4878 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4879 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004880
4881 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4882 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4883 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4884 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4885 adding this value to the client's port.
4886
4887 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4888 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004889 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004890
4891 Examples :
4892 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4893 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4894
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004895 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4896 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004897
4898
4899source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004900source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004901source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004902 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 yes | no | yes | yes
4905 Arguments :
4906 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4907 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4908 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4909 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4910
4911 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4912 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004913 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4914 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4915 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004916
4917 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4918 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4919 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4920 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4921 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4922 <addr>.
4923
4924 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4925 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4926 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4927 port.
4928
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004929 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4930 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4931 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4932 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4933 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4934 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4935 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4936 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4937 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4938 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4939 HTTP header.
4940
4941 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4942 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004943 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004944 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4945 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4946 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4947 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4948 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4949 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4950 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4951
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004952 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4953 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4954 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4955 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4956 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4957 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4958
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004959 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4960 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4961 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4962 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4963
4964 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4965 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4966 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4967 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4968 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4969 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4970
4971 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4972 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4973 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4974 there are two methods :
4975
4976 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4977 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4978 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4979 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4980 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4981 of the client ranges may be used.
4982
4983 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4984 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4985 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4986 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4987 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4988 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4989 same session.
4990
4991 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4992 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4993 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4994 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4995 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4996 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4997
4998 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4999 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5000 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005001 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005002
5003 Examples :
5004 backend private
5005 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5006 source 192.168.1.200
5007
5008 backend transparent_ssl1
5009 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5010 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5011
5012 backend transparent_ssl2
5013 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5014 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5015 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5016
5017 backend transparent_ssl3
5018 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5019 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5020 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5021
5022 backend transparent_smtp
5023 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5024 # with Tproxy version 4.
5025 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5026
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005027 backend transparent_http
5028 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5029 # proxy.
5030 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005032 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005033 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005035
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005036srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5037 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | yes | yes
5040 Arguments :
5041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5043 as explained at the top of this document.
5044
5045 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5046 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5047 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5048 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5049 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5050 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5051 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5052
5053 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5054 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5055 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5056 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5057 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005058 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005059 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005060 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005061
5062 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5064 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5065 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5066 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5067 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5068
5069 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5070 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5071
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005072 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5073 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005074
5075
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005076stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5077 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 no | no | yes | yes
5080
5081 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5082 matched.
5083
5084 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5085 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5086
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005087 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5088 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5089 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5090
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005091 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5092 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5093 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5094 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005095
5096 Example :
5097 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5098 backend stats_localhost
5099 stats enable
5100 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5101
5102 Example :
5103 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5104 backend stats_auth
5105 stats enable
5106 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5107 stats admin if TRUE
5108
5109 Example :
5110 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5111 userlist stats-auth
5112 group admin users admin
5113 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5114 group readonly users haproxy
5115 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5116
5117 backend stats_auth
5118 stats enable
5119 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5120 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5121 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5122 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5123
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005124 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5125 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5126 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005127
5128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005129stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5130 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 yes | no | yes | yes
5133 Arguments :
5134 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5135
5136 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5137
5138 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5139 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5140 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5141 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5142 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5143 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5144
5145 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5146 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5147 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005148 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005149
5150 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5151 report using "stats scope".
5152
5153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5155 unobvious parameters.
5156
5157 Example :
5158 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5159 backend public_www
5160 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5161 stats enable
5162 stats hide-version
5163 stats scope .
5164 stats uri /admin?stats
5165 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5166 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5167 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5168
5169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5170 backend private_monitoring
5171 stats enable
5172 stats uri /admin?stats
5173 stats refresh 5s
5174
5175 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5176
5177
5178stats enable
5179 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5181 yes | no | yes | yes
5182 Arguments : none
5183
5184 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5185 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5186 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5187 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5188 - stats auth : no authentication
5189 - stats scope : no restriction
5190
5191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5193 unobvious parameters.
5194
5195 Example :
5196 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5197 backend public_www
5198 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5199 stats enable
5200 stats hide-version
5201 stats scope .
5202 stats uri /admin?stats
5203 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5204 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5205 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5206
5207 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5208 backend private_monitoring
5209 stats enable
5210 stats uri /admin?stats
5211 stats refresh 5s
5212
5213 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5214
5215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005216stats hide-version
5217 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005220 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005221
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005222 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5223 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5224 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5225 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5226 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5227 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005229 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5230 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5231 unobvious parameters.
5232
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005233 Example :
5234 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5235 backend public_www
5236 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005237 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005238 stats hide-version
5239 stats scope .
5240 stats uri /admin?stats
5241 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5242 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5243 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005244
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005245 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5246 backend private_monitoring
5247 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005248 stats uri /admin?stats
5249 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005250
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005251 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005252
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005253
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005254stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5255 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5256 Access control for statistics
5257
5258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5259 no | no | yes | yes
5260
5261 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5262 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5263 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5264 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5265 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5266 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5267
5268 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5269 instance.
5270
5271 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5272 about ACL usage.
5273
5274
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005275stats realm <realm>
5276 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
5279 Arguments :
5280 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5281 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5282 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5283
5284 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5285 using a backslash ('\').
5286
5287 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5288 only related to authentication.
5289
5290 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5291 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5292 unobvious parameters.
5293
5294 Example :
5295 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5296 backend public_www
5297 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5298 stats enable
5299 stats hide-version
5300 stats scope .
5301 stats uri /admin?stats
5302 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5303 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5304 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5305
5306 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5307 backend private_monitoring
5308 stats enable
5309 stats uri /admin?stats
5310 stats refresh 5s
5311
5312 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5313
5314
5315stats refresh <delay>
5316 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | no | yes | yes
5319 Arguments :
5320 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5321 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5322 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5323 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5324 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5325 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5326
5327 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5328 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5329 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5330 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5331
5332 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5333 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5334 unobvious parameters.
5335
5336 Example :
5337 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5338 backend public_www
5339 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5340 stats enable
5341 stats hide-version
5342 stats scope .
5343 stats uri /admin?stats
5344 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5345 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5346 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5347
5348 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5349 backend private_monitoring
5350 stats enable
5351 stats uri /admin?stats
5352 stats refresh 5s
5353
5354 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5355
5356
5357stats scope { <name> | "." }
5358 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | no | yes | yes
5361 Arguments :
5362 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5363 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5364 section in which the statement appears.
5365
5366 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5367 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5368 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5369 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5370 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5371 exists.
5372
5373 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5374 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5375 unobvious parameters.
5376
5377 Example :
5378 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5379 backend public_www
5380 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5381 stats enable
5382 stats hide-version
5383 stats scope .
5384 stats uri /admin?stats
5385 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5386 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5387 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5388
5389 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5390 backend private_monitoring
5391 stats enable
5392 stats uri /admin?stats
5393 stats refresh 5s
5394
5395 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5396
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005397
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005398stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005399 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 yes | no | yes | yes
5402
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005403 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005404 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5405
5406 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5407 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5408
5409 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5410 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005411 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005412
5413 Example :
5414 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5415 backend private_monitoring
5416 stats enable
5417 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5418 stats uri /admin?stats
5419 stats refresh 5s
5420
5421 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5422 global section.
5423
5424
5425stats show-legends
5426 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5427 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5428 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5429 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5430 - IP (socket, server)
5431 - cookie (backend, server)
5432
5433 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5434 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005435 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005436
5437 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5438
5439
5440stats show-node [ <name> ]
5441 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5443 yes | no | yes | yes
5444 Arguments:
5445 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5446 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5447
5448 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5449 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005450 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005451
5452 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5453 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5454 unobvious parameters.
5455
5456 Example:
5457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5458 backend private_monitoring
5459 stats enable
5460 stats show-node Europe-1
5461 stats uri /admin?stats
5462 stats refresh 5s
5463
5464 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5465 section.
5466
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005467
5468stats uri <prefix>
5469 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5471 yes | no | yes | yes
5472 Arguments :
5473 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5474 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5475 query string.
5476
5477 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5478 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5479 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5480 possible to reach it in the application.
5481
5482 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005483 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005484 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5485 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5486 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5487 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5488
5489 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5490 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5491 an address or a port to statistics only.
5492
5493 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5494 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5495 unobvious parameters.
5496
5497 Example :
5498 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5499 backend public_www
5500 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5501 stats enable
5502 stats hide-version
5503 stats scope .
5504 stats uri /admin?stats
5505 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5506 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5507 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5508
5509 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5510 backend private_monitoring
5511 stats enable
5512 stats uri /admin?stats
5513 stats refresh 5s
5514
5515 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5516
5517
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005518stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5519 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005521 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005522
5523 Arguments :
5524 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5525 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5526 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5527 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5528
5529 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5530 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5531 the "stick-table" statement.
5532
5533 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5534 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5535 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5536 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5537 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5538
5539 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5540 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5541 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5542 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5543 transformation rules.
5544
5545 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5546 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5547 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5548 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5549 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5550 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5551 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5552
5553 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5554 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5555 ACL based conditions.
5556
5557 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5558 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5559 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5560 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5561
5562 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5563 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5564 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5565 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5566
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005567 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5568 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5569 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5570
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005571 Example :
5572 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5573 # last 30 minutes
5574 backend pop
5575 mode tcp
5576 balance roundrobin
5577 stick store-request src
5578 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5579 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5580 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5581
5582 backend smtp
5583 mode tcp
5584 balance roundrobin
5585 stick match src table pop
5586 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5587 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5588
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005589 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5590 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005591
5592
5593stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5594 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5596 no | no | yes | yes
5597
5598 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5599 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5600 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5601 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5602
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005603 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5604 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5605 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5606
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005607 Examples :
5608 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005609 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005610
5611 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5612 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5613 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5614
5615
5616 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5617 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5618 backend http
5619 mode http
5620 balance roundrobin
5621 stick on src table https
5622 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5623 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5624 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5625
5626 backend https
5627 mode tcp
5628 balance roundrobin
5629 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5630 stick on src
5631 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5632 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5633
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005634 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005635
5636
5637stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5638 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5640 no | no | yes | yes
5641
5642 Arguments :
5643 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5644 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5645 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5646 server is selected.
5647
5648 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5649 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5650 the "stick-table" statement.
5651
5652 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5653 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5654 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5655 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5656 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5657 address.
5658
5659 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5660 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5661 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5662 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5663 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5664 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5665 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5666 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5667 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5668 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5669
5670 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5671 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5672 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5673 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5674 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5675 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5676 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5677
5678 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5679 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5680 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5681 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5682
5683 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5684 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5685 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5686 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5687 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5688 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5689 another protocol or access method.
5690
5691 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5692 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5693 the request.
5694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005695 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5696 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5697 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5698
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005699 Example :
5700 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5701 # last 30 minutes
5702 backend pop
5703 mode tcp
5704 balance roundrobin
5705 stick store-request src
5706 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5707 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5708 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5709
5710 backend smtp
5711 mode tcp
5712 balance roundrobin
5713 stick match src table pop
5714 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5715 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005717 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5718 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005719
5720
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005721stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005722 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5723 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005724 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005726 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005727
5728 Arguments :
5729 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5730 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5731 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5732 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5733
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005734 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5735 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5736 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5737 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5738
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005739 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5740 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5741 instance.
5742
5743 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5744 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5745 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5746 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5747 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5748 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005749 to 32 characters.
5750
5751 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5752 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5753 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5754 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5755 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5756 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005757
5758 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005759 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5760 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005761 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5762 increase.
5763
5764 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005765 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5766 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5767 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005768
5769 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5770 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5771 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5772 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5773 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5774 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5775 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5776 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5777 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5778 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5779 parameter (see below).
5780
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005781 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5782 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5783 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5784 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5785 soft restart.
5786
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005787 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5788
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005789 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5790 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5791 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5792 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5793 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005794 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005795 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5796 if not expiration delay is specified.
5797
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005798 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5799 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5800 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5801 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005802 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5803 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5804 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5805 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5806 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5807 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5808 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5809 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5810 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5811 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5812 types and their arguments.
5813
5814 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5815 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5816 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5817 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5818
5819 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5820 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5821 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5822 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5823
5824 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5825 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5826 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5827 they were received.
5828
5829 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5830 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5831 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5832 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5833 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5834
5835 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5836 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5837 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5838 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5839 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5840
5841 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5842 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5843 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5844
5845 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5846 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5847 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5848 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5849 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5850
5851 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5852 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5853 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5854 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5855 the client side.
5856
5857 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5858 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5859 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5860 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5861 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5862 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5863 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5864
5865 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5866 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5867 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5868 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5869 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5870 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5871 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5872
5873 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5874 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5875 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5876 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5877 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5878 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5879
5880 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5881 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5882 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5883 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5884
5885 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5886 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5887 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5888 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5889 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5890 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5891 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5892 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5893 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5894 recommended for better fairness.
5895
5896 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5897 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5898 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5899 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5900
5901 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5902 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5903 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5904 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5905 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5906 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5907 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5908 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5909 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5910 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005911
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005912 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5913 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005914 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5915 reference it.
5916
5917 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5918 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5919 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5920 as an exclusive stickiness.
5921
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005922 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5923 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5924 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5925 something that can be ignored.
5926
5927 Example:
5928 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5929 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5930 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5931 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5932
5933 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005934 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005935
5936
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005937stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5938 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5940 no | no | yes | yes
5941
5942 Arguments :
5943 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5944 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5945 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5946 server is selected.
5947
5948 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5949 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5950 the "stick-table" statement.
5951
5952 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5953 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5954 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5955 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5956
5957 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5958 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5959 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5960 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5961 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5962 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005963 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005964 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5965 rules.
5966
5967 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5968 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5969 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5970 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5971 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5972 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5973 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5974
5975 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5976 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5977 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5978 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5979
5980 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5981 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5982 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5983 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5984 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5985 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5986 another protocol or access method.
5987
5988 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5989
5990 Example :
5991 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5992 backend https
5993 mode tcp
5994 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005995 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005996 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005997
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005998 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5999 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6000
6001 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6002 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6003 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6004
6005 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6006 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006007
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006008 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6009 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6010 # at offset 44.
6011
6012 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6013 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6014
6015 # Learn on response if server hello.
6016 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006017
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006018 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6019 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6020
6021 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6022 extraction.
6023
6024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006025tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6026 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006029 Arguments :
6030 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6031 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6032 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006034 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006035
6036 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6037 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006038 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6039 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6040 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6041 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6042 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6043 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006045 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6046 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6047 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6048 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006050 Three types of actions are supported :
6051 - accept :
6052 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6053 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6054 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 - reject :
6057 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6058 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6059 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6060 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6061 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6062 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6063 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6064 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6065 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6066 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6067 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6068 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006070 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6071 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6072 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6073 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6074 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6075 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6076 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6077 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6078 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006080 These actions take one or two arguments :
6081 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6082 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6083 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006085 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6086 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6087 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6088 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006090 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6091 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6092 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6093 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6094 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6095 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6096 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6097 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6098 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6099 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6102 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6103 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006105 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6106 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6107 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006110 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006111 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6114 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6115 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006117 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6118 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6119 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006120
6121 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006124
6125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006126tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6127 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006129 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006130 Arguments :
6131 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6132 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6133 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006135 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006137 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6138 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6139 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6140 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6141 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006143 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6144 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6145 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6146 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6147 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6148 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6149 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6150 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6151 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006152
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006153 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6154 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6155 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6156 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006158 Three types of actions are supported :
6159 - accept :
6160 - reject :
6161 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006163 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6164 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006166 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6167 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6168 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6169 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6170 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6171 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006173 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006174 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6175 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006177 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006178 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6179 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6180 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6181 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6182 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006183
6184 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006185 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6186 # and reject everything else.
6187 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6188 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006189 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006190 tcp-request content reject
6191
6192 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006193 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6194 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6195 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006196 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006197
6198 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6199 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6200 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006201 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006202 tcp-request content reject
6203
6204 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6205 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6206
6207 frontend http
6208 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6209 # protecting all our sites
6210 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6211 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6212 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6213 ...
6214 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6215
6216 backend http_dynamic
6217 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6218 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6219 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6220 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6221 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6222 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6223 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006225 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006227 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006228
6229
6230tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6231 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006233 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006234 Arguments :
6235 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6236 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6237 as explained at the top of this document.
6238
6239 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6240 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6241 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6242 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6243 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6244
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006245 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6246 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6247 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6248 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6249
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006250 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6251 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006252 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006253 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006254 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6255 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6256 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6257 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006258
6259 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6260 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6261 it pass through unaffected.
6262
6263 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6264 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6265 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006266 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006267 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6268 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006269 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6270 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6271 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006272
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006273 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006274 "timeout client".
6275
6276
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006277tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6278 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6280 no | no | yes | yes
6281 Arguments :
6282 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6283 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6284 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6285
6286 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6287
6288 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6289 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6290 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6291 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006292 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006293
6294 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6295
6296 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6297 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6298 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6299 inserted.
6300
6301 Two types of actions are supported :
6302 - accept :
6303 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6304 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6305 the rules evaluation.
6306
6307 - reject :
6308 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6309 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006310 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006311
6312 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6313 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6314 for changing the default action to a reject.
6315
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006316 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6317 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6318 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6319 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006320 period.
6321
6322 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6323
6324 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6325
6326
6327tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6328 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 no | no | yes | yes
6331 Arguments :
6332 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6333 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6334 as explained at the top of this document.
6335
6336 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6337
6338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006339timeout check <timeout>
6340 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6341 established.
6342
6343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6344 yes | no | yes | yes
6345 Arguments:
6346 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6347 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6348 as explained at the top of this document.
6349
6350 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6351 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6352 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6353 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006354 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6355 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6356 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006357
6358 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6359 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6360
6361 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6362 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006363 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006364
6365 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6366 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6367 forget about it.
6368
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006369 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6370 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006371
6372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373timeout client <timeout>
6374timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6375 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | yes | yes | no
6378 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6381 as explained at the top of this document.
6382
6383 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6384 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6385 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6386 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6387 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6388 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6389 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6390 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006391 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006392 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006393 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6394 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6395 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006396
6397 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6398 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6399 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6400 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6401 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6402 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6403
6404 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6405 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6406 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6407
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006408 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006409
6410
6411timeout connect <timeout>
6412timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6413 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6415 yes | no | yes | yes
6416 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006417 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006418 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6419 as explained at the top of this document.
6420
6421 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006422 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006423 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006424 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006425 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6426 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006427
6428 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6429 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6430 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6431 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6432 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6433 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6434
6435 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6436 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6437 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6438
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006439 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6440 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006441
6442
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006443timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6444 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | yes | yes | yes
6447 Arguments :
6448 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6449 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6450 as explained at the top of this document.
6451
6452 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6453 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6454 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6455 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6456 once the request has started to present itself.
6457
6458 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6459 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6460 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6461 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6462 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6463
6464 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6465 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6466 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6467 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6468
6469 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6470 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6471 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6472 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6473 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006474 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006475
6476 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6477 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6478 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6479 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6480
6481 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6482
6483
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006484timeout http-request <timeout>
6485 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006487 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006488 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006489 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006490 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6491 as explained at the top of this document.
6492
6493 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6494 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6495 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6496 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6497 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6498 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6499 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6500 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6501
6502 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6503 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006504 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6505 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006506
6507 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6508 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6509 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6510 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6511 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6512
6513 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006514 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6515 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6516 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006517
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006518 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006519
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006520
6521timeout queue <timeout>
6522 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6524 yes | no | yes | yes
6525 Arguments :
6526 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6528 as explained at the top of this document.
6529
6530 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6531 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6532 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6533 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6534 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6535
6536 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6537 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6538 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6539 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6540
6541 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6542
6543
6544timeout server <timeout>
6545timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6546 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6548 yes | no | yes | yes
6549 Arguments :
6550 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6551 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6552 as explained at the top of this document.
6553
6554 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6555 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6556 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6557 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6558 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6559 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6560 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6561
6562 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6563 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6564 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6565 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6566 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006567 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006568 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006569 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6570 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6571 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6572 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006573
6574 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6575 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6576 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6577 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6578 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6579 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6580
6581 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6582 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6583 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6584
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006585 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006586
6587
6588timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006589 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6591 yes | yes | yes | yes
6592 Arguments :
6593 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6594 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6595 as explained at the top of this document.
6596
6597 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6598 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6599 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6600
6601 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6602 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6603 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6604 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006605 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006606
6607 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6608
6609
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006610timeout tunnel <timeout>
6611 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6613 yes | no | yes | yes
6614 Arguments :
6615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6617 as explained at the top of this document.
6618
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006619 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006620 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6621 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6622 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6623 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6624 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6625 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6626 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6627 specified.
6628
6629 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6630 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6631 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6632 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6633 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6634
6635 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6636 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6637 forget about it.
6638
6639 Example :
6640 defaults http
6641 option http-server-close
6642 timeout connect 5s
6643 timeout client 30s
6644 timeout client 30s
6645 timeout server 30s
6646 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6647
6648 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6649
6650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006651transparent (deprecated)
6652 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006654 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006655 Arguments : none
6656
6657 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6658 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6659 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6660 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6661 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6662 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6663 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6664 appropriate server.
6665
6666 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6667
6668 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6669 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6670
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006671 See also: "option transparent"
6672
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006673unique-id-format <string>
6674 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6676 yes | yes | yes | no
6677 Arguments :
6678 <string> is a log-format string.
6679
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006680 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6681 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6682 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6683 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006684
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006685 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6686 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6687 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6688 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6689 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6690 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6691 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6692 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006694 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6695 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006696
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006697 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006698
6699 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6700
6701 will generate:
6702
6703 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6704
6705 See also: "unique-id-header"
6706
6707unique-id-header <name>
6708 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 yes | yes | yes | no
6711 Arguments :
6712 <name> is the name of the header.
6713
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006714 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6715 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006716
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006717 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006718
6719 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6720 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6721
6722 will generate:
6723
6724 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6725
6726 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006727
6728use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6729use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006730 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 no | yes | yes | no
6733 Arguments :
6734 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006736 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006737
6738 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6739 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6740 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006741 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6742 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6743 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6744 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006745
6746 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6747 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6748 assign the backend.
6749
6750 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6751 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6752 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6753 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6754 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6755 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6756
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006757 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006758 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006759 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6760 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6761 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6762
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006763 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006764
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006765
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006766use-server <server> if <condition>
6767use-server <server> unless <condition>
6768 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6770 no | no | yes | yes
6771 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006772 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006773
6774 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6775
6776 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6777 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6778 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6779
6780 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6781 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6782 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6783 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6784 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6785 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6786 matches will assign the server.
6787
6788 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6789 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6790 with the next rules until one matches.
6791
6792 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6793 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6794 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6795 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6796
6797 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6798 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6799 stripped.
6800
6801 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6802 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6803 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6804 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6805
6806 Example :
6807 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6808 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6809 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6810 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6811 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6812 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6813 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6814 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6815 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6816
6817 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6818
6819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010068205. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006821------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006823The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6824which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6825arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6826settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6827after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6828Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6829address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006831 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006832 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006834The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006835
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006836addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006837 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6838 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6839 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6840 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6841 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006843 Supported in default-server: No
6844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006845backup
6846 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6847 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6848 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6849 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6850 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6851 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006853 Supported in default-server: No
6854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006855check
6856 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006857 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6858 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6859 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6860 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6861 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6862 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6863 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6864 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6865 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6866 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006868 Supported in default-server: No
6869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006870cookie <value>
6871 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6872 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6873 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6874 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6875 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6876 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6877 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006879 Supported in default-server: No
6880
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006881disabled
6882 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6883 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6884 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6885 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6886 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6887
6888 Supported in default-server: No
6889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006890error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006891 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6892 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6893 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006895 Supported in default-server: Yes
6896
6897 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006899fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006900 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6901 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6902 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006904 Supported in default-server: Yes
6905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006906id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006907 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6908 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6909 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006911 Supported in default-server: No
6912
6913inter <delay>
6914fastinter <delay>
6915downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006916 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6917 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6918 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6919 between checks depending on the server state :
6920
6921 Server state | Interval used
6922 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6923 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6924 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6925 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6926 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6927 or yet unchecked. |
6928 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6929 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6930 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006932 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6933 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6934 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6935 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6936 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6937 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6938 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6939 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6940 servers.
6941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006942 Supported in default-server: Yes
6943
6944maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006945 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6946 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6947 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6948 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6949 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6950 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6951 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6952 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006954 Supported in default-server: Yes
6955
6956maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006957 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6958 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6959 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6960 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6961 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6962 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6963 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006965 Supported in default-server: Yes
6966
6967minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006968 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6969 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6970 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6971 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6972 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6973 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006974 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006975 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006977 Supported in default-server: Yes
6978
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006979non-stick
6980 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6981 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6982 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006984observe <mode>
6985 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6986 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6987 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6988 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6989 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6990 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006991 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006993 Supported in default-server: No
6994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006995 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6996
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006997on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006998 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6999 Currently, four modes are available:
7000 - fastinter: force fastinter
7001 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7002 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7003 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7004 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007006 Supported in default-server: Yes
7007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007008 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7009
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007010on-marked-down <action>
7011 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7012 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007013 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7014 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7015 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7016 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7017 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7018 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7019 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7020 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007021
7022 Actions are disabled by default
7023
7024 Supported in default-server: Yes
7025
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007026on-marked-up <action>
7027 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7028 Currently one action is available:
7029 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7030 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7031 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7032 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7033 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7034 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7035 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7036 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7037
7038 Actions are disabled by default
7039
7040 Supported in default-server: Yes
7041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007042port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007043 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7044 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7045 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7046 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7047 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7048 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007050 Supported in default-server: Yes
7051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007052redir <prefix>
7053 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7054 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7055 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7056 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7057 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7058 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7059 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7060 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007061 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007062 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7063 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7064 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7065 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7066 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7067
7068 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007070 Supported in default-server: No
7071
7072rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007073 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7074 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7075 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007077 Supported in default-server: Yes
7078
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007079send-proxy
7080 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7081 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7082 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7083 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7084 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7085 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7086 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7087 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7088 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7089 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7090 option of the "bind" keyword.
7091
7092 Supported in default-server: No
7093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007094slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007095 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7096 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7097 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7098 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7099 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7100 parameters :
7101
7102 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7103 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7104
7105 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7106 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7107 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7108 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7109
7110 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7111 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7112 seen as failed.
7113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007114 Supported in default-server: Yes
7115
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007116source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007117source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007118source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007119 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7120 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7121 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7122 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7123
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007124 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7125 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7126 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7127 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7128 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7129 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7130 server.
7131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007132 Supported in default-server: No
7133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007134track [<proxy>/]<server>
7135 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7136 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7137 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7138 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7139 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007141 Supported in default-server: No
7142
7143weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007144 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7145 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7146 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007147 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7148 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7149 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7150 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7151 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7152 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007154 Supported in default-server: Yes
7155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007156
71576. HTTP header manipulation
7158---------------------------
7159
7160In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7161response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7162request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7163which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7164against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7165to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7166passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7167headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7168never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7169
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007170There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7171(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7172rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7173messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7174in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007175happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007176add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7177normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007179This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7180in section 4.2 :
7181
7182 - reqadd <string>
7183 - reqallow <search>
7184 - reqiallow <search>
7185 - reqdel <search>
7186 - reqidel <search>
7187 - reqdeny <search>
7188 - reqideny <search>
7189 - reqpass <search>
7190 - reqipass <search>
7191 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7192 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7193 - reqtarpit <search>
7194 - reqitarpit <search>
7195 - rspadd <string>
7196 - rspdel <search>
7197 - rspidel <search>
7198 - rspdeny <search>
7199 - rspideny <search>
7200 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7201 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7202
7203With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7204is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7205parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7206prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7207Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7208
7209 \t for a tab
7210 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7211 \n for a new line (LF)
7212 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7213 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7214 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7215 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7216 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7217
7218The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7219portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7220above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7221regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
72229 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7223is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7224
7225The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7226after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7227
7228Notes related to these keywords :
7229---------------------------------
7230 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7231 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7232 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7233
7234 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7235 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7236 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7237
7238 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7239 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7240 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7241 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7242 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7243
7244 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7245 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7246 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7247 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7248 useless headers before adding new ones.
7249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007250 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007251 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7252
7253 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7254 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7255 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7256
7257 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7258 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007259 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007260
7261
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010072627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7263------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007264
7265The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7266content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7267from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7268simple :
7269
7270 - define test criteria with sets of values
7271 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7272
7273The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7274
7275In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7276
7277 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7278
7279This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7280Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7281and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7282an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7283of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7284
7285ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7286'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7287which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7288
7289There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7290performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7291
7292The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7293
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007294 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7295 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007296 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7297
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007298The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7299specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7300possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007301multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7302be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7303needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7304space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7305match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7306lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7307duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007308to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007309instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007310
7311 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7312
7313In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7314the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7315case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7316too.
7317
7318Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7319a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7320ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007322Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007324 - integers or integer ranges
7325 - strings
7326 - regular expressions
7327 - IP addresses and networks
7328
7329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073307.1. Matching integers
7331----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007332
7333Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7334that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7335expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7336may be omitted.
7337
7338For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7339unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7340representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7341
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007342As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7343two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7344instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7345ranges and operators.
7346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007347For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007348operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7349Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7350of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007352Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007353
7354 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7355 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7356 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7357 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7358 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007360For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007361
7362 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7363
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007364This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7365
7366 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7367
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073697.2. Matching strings
7370---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007371
7372String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7373exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7374characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7375string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7376to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007377before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007378
7379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073807.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7381-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007382
7383Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7384they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7385possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7386passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7387the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007388the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7389match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007390
7391
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020073927.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007393----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007394
7395IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7396netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7397within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007398host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007399difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7400at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7401does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7402parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007403
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007404IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7405Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7406trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7407IPv6 patterns.
7408
7409HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7410following situations :
7411 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7412 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7413 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7414 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7415 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7416 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7417 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7418 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7419 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7420 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7421
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074237.5. Available matching criteria
7424--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074267.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7427------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007428
7429A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7430analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007431addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007432
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007433always_false
7434 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7435 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7436
7437always_true
7438 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7439 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007441avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007442avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007443 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7444 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7445 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7446 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7447 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7448 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7449 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7450 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7451 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7452 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7453 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007454
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007455be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007456be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007457 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7458 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7459 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7460 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7461 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007462
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007463be_id <integer>
7464 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7465 backend it was called.
7466
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007467be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007468be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007469 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7470 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7471 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7472 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7473 sucking of an online dictionary).
7474
7475 Example :
7476 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7477 backend dynamic
7478 mode http
7479 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7480 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007481
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007482connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007483connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007484 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007485 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007486 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7487
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007488 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7489 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007490
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007491 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007492 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7493 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7494 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7495 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7496 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007497 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007498
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007499 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7500 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7501 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7502 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007503
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007504dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007505 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7506 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007507
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007508dst_conn <integer>
7509 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7510 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7511 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7512 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7513 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7514 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7515
7516dst_port <integer>
7517 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7518 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7519
7520fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007521fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007522 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7523 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7524 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7525 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7526 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7527 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7528 criteria.
7529
7530fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007531 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007532 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007533
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007534fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007535fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007536 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7537 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7538 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7539 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7540 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7541 the rate to go down below the limit.
7542
7543 Example :
7544 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7545 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7546 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7547 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7548 frontend mail
7549 bind :25
7550 mode tcp
7551 maxconn 100
7552 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7553 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7554 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7555 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007556
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007557nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007558nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007559 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7560 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7561 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7562 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7563 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007564
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007565queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007566queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007567 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7568 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7569 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7570 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7571 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7572 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7573 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007575sc1_bytes_in_rate
7576sc2_bytes_in_rate
7577 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7578 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7579 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7580
7581sc1_bytes_out_rate
7582sc2_bytes_out_rate
7583 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7584 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7585 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7586
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007587sc1_clr_gpc0
7588sc2_clr_gpc0
7589 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7590 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7591 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7592 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7593 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7594 was verified :
7595
7596 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7597 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7598 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7599 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7600 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7601 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7602 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007604sc1_conn_cnt
7605sc2_conn_cnt
7606 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7607 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7608
7609sc1_conn_cur
7610sc2_conn_cur
7611 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7612 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7613 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7614
7615sc1_conn_rate
7616sc2_conn_rate
7617 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7618 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7619 See also src_conn_rate.
7620
7621sc1_get_gpc0
7622sc2_get_gpc0
7623 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7624 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7625
7626sc1_http_err_cnt
7627sc2_http_err_cnt
7628 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7629 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7630 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7631
7632sc1_http_err_rate
7633sc2_http_err_rate
7634 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7635 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7636 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7637 src_http_err_rate.
7638
7639sc1_http_req_cnt
7640sc2_http_req_cnt
7641 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7642 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7643 src_http_req_cnt.
7644
7645sc1_http_req_rate
7646sc2_http_req_rate
7647 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7648 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7649 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7650 src_http_req_rate.
7651
7652sc1_inc_gpc0
7653sc2_inc_gpc0
7654 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7655 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7656 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7657 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7658 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7659 when a first ACL was verified :
7660
7661 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7662 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7663 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7664
7665sc1_kbytes_in
7666sc2_kbytes_in
7667 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7668 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7669 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7670 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7671
7672sc1_kbytes_out
7673sc2_kbytes_out
7674 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7675 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7676 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7677 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7678
7679sc1_sess_cnt
7680sc2_sess_cnt
7681 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7682 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7683 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7684 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007685 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007686 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7687
7688sc1_sess_rate
7689sc2_sess_rate
7690 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7691 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7692 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7693 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7694 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007695 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007696
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007697so_id <integer>
7698 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7699
7700src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007701 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7702 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7703 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007704
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007705src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007706src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007707 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7708 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7709 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007710 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007711
7712src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007713src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007714 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7715 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7716 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007717 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007718
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007719src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7720src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7721 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7722 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7723 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7724 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7725 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7726 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7727
7728 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7729 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7730 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7731 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7732 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7733 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7734 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7735
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007736src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007737src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007738 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7739 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7740 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007741 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007742
7743src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007744src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007745 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7746 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7747 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007748 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007749
7750src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007751src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007752 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7753 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7754 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007755 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007756
7757src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007758src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007759 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7760 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7761 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007762 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007763
7764src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007765src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007766 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7767 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7768 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007769 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007770
7771src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007772src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007773 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7774 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7775 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7776 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007777 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007778
7779src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007780src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007781 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7782 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7783 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007784 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007785
7786src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007787src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007788 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7789 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7790 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7791 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007792 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007793
7794src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007795src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007796 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7797 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7798 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7799 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7800 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7801 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7802
7803 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7804 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007805 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007806
7807src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007808src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007809 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7810 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7811 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7812 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007813 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007814
7815src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007816src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007817 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7818 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7819 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7820 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007821 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007822
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007823src_port <integer>
7824 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007825
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007826src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007827src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007828 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7829 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7830 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7831 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007832 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007833
7834src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007835src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007836 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7837 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7838 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7839 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007840 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007841
7842src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007843src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007844 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007845 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7846 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007847 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7848 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7849 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007850 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007851
7852 Example :
7853 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7854 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7855 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7856 listen ssh
7857 bind :22
7858 mode tcp
7859 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007860 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007861 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7862 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7863
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007864srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007865 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7866 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7867 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7868 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7869
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007870srv_id <integer>
7871 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7872
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007873srv_is_up(<server>)
7874srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7875 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7876 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7877 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7878 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7879 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7880 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7881 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7882 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7883
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007884table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007885table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007886 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7887 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7888
7889table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007890table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007891 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7892 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7893 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020078967.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7897---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007898
7899A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7900during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007901through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7902keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007903
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007904is_ssl
7905 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
7906 and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared with
7907 a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
7908
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007909rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7910 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7911 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7912 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007913 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
7914 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
7915 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007916
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007917req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007918 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007919 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7920 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7921 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7922 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7923 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7924 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7925
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007926req_proto_http
7927 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7928 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007929 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007930 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7931 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7932
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007933req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007934req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007935 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7936 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7937 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7938 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7939 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7940 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7941 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7942 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7943
7944req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007945req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007946 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7947 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7948 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7949 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7950 cookies.
7951
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007952req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7953 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7954 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7955 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007956 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
7957 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
7958 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007959
7960req_ssl_sni <string>
7961 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7962 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7963 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7964 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7965 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7966 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7967 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007968 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
7969 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
7970 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
7971 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007972
7973 Examples :
7974 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7975 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7976 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7977 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7978 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7979
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007980req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7981 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7982 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7983 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7984 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7985 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7986 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02007987 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
7988 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
7989 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
7990 option.
7991
7992ssl_sni <string>
7993 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
7994 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
7995 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
7996 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
7997 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
7998 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
7999 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8000
8001ssl_has_sni
8002 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8003 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer. Returns true
8004 when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires that
8005 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8006
8007ssl_sni <string>
8008 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8009 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8010 the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8011 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8012 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8013 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. See also ssl_sni_end
8014 and ssl_sni_req below. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8015 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8016
8017ssl_sni_end <string>
8018 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8019 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8020 the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8021 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8022 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8023 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8024 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8025
8026ssl_sni_req <regex>
8027 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS data layer
8028 which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension sent by
8029 the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field (when
8030 present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different from
8031 req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered by
8032 haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires that
8033 the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008034
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008035wait_end
8036 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8037 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8038 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8039 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8040 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8041 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8042 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8043 inspection.
8044
8045 Examples :
8046 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8047 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8048 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8049
8050 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8051 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8052 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8053 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8054 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8055 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8056 tcp-request content reject
8057
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080597.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8060--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008061
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008062A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008063application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8064read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8065than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8066
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008067base <string>
8068 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8069 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8070 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8071 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8072 See also "path" and "uri".
8073
8074base_beg <string>
8075 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8076 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8077 "path_beg".
8078
8079base_dir <string>
8080 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8081 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8082 "path_dir" instead.
8083
8084base_dom <string>
8085 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8086 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8087 instead.
8088
8089base_end <string>
8090 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8091 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8092
8093base_len <integer>
8094 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8095 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8096
8097base_reg <regex>
8098 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8099 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8100 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8101 and all "base_" criteria.
8102
8103base_sub <string>
8104 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8105 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8106 also "base_dir".
8107
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008108cook(<name>) <string>
8109 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8110 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8111 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8112 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8113 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8114 sent by the server.
8115
8116 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8117 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8118 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8119
8120 cook(profile) silver gold
8121
8122cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8123 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8124 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8125 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8126
8127cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8128 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8129 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8130 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8131 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8132 server.
8133
8134cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8135 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8136 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8137 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8138 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8139 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8140
8141cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8142 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8143 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8144 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8145 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8146
8147cook_end(<name>) <string>
8148 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8149 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8150 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8151
8152cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8153 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8154 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8155 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8156 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8157 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8158
8159cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8160 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8161 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8162 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8163 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8164 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8165
8166cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8167 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8168 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8169 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8170
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008171cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8172 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8173 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8174 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8175 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8176 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8177
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008179hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008180 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8181 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8182 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8183 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008184 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8185 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8186 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8187 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8188 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008189
8190 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008191 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008192 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8193
8194 hdr(Connection) -i close
8195
8196hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008197hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008198 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8199 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8200 response headers sent by the server.
8201
8202hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008203hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008204 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8205 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8206 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8207 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8208 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8209 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8210 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8211
8212hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008213hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008214 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8215 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8216 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8217 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8218 headers sent by the server.
8219
8220hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008221hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008222 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8223 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8224 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8225 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8226 server.
8227
8228hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008229hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008230 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8231 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8232 response headers sent by the server.
8233
8234hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008235hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8236 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8237 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8238 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008239 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8240
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008241hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008242hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008243 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8244 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8245 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8246 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8247
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008248hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008249hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008250 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008251 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8252 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8253 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8254 response headers sent by the server.
8255
8256hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008257hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008258 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8259 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8260 response headers sent by the server.
8261
8262hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008263hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008264 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8265 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8266 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8267 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8268
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008269http_auth(<userlist>)
8270http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008271 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8272 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8273 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8274 of specified groups.
8275
8276 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8277
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008278http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008279 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8280 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8281 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8282 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8283
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008284method <string>
8285 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8286 already check for most common methods.
8287
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008288path <string>
8289 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8290 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8291 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8292
8293path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008294 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8295 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008297path_dir <string>
8298 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8299 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8300 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8301 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8302
8303path_dom <string>
8304 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8305 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8306 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8307
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008308path_end <string>
8309 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8310 control file name extension.
8311
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008312path_len <integer>
8313 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8314 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008316path_reg <regex>
8317 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8318 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8319 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8320
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008321path_sub <string>
8322 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8323 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8324 "path_dir".
8325
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008326payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8327 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8328 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8329 strings.
8330
8331payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8332 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8333 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8334 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8335 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8336 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8337
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008338req_ver <string>
8339 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8340 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8341
8342status <integer>
8343 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8344 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8345 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008347url <string>
8348 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008349 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008350
8351url_beg <string>
8352 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008353 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8354 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008355
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008356url_dir <string>
8357 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8358 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8359 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8360 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8361
8362url_dom <string>
8363 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8364 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8365 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8366
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008367url_end <string>
8368 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8369 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008370
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008371url_ip <address>
8372 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8373 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8374 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008375
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008376url_len <integer>
8377 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8378 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8379
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008380url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008381 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8382 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008383 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008384 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008385
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008386url_reg <regex>
8387 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8388 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008389 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008390
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008391url_sub <string>
8392 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8393 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008394
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008395urlp(<name>) <string>
8396 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8397 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8398
8399 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8400 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8401
8402urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8403 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8404 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8405 protocol scheme.
8406
8407urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8408 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8409 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8410 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8411 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8412
8413urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8414 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8415 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8416 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8417 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8418
8419urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8420 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8421
8422urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008423 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8424 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008425
8426urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8427 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8428 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8429
8430urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8431 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8432 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8433 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8434 "urlp_" criteria.
8435
8436urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8437 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8438 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8439 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8440
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008441urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8442 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8443 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8444 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8445 negative data.
8446
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084487.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8449---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008451Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8452every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008453order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008455ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8456---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008457FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008458HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008459HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8460HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008461HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8462HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8463HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8464HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8465LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008466METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8467METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8468METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8469METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8470METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8471METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008472RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008473REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008474TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008475WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8476---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008477
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084797.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8480----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008482Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8483combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008485 - AND (implicit)
8486 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8487 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008489A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008491 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008493Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8494indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008496For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8497"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8498requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8499is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008501 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8502 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8503 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8504 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008506To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8507and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008509 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8510 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8511 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8512 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008514 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8515 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8516 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8517 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008518
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008519It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8520expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8521be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008522the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008523
8524 The following rule :
8525
8526 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8527 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8528
8529 Can also be written that way :
8530
8531 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8532
8533It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8534to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8535simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8536sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8537good use is the following :
8538
8539 With named ACLs :
8540
8541 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8542 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8543 monitor fail if site_dead
8544
8545 With anonymous ACLs :
8546
8547 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008549See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008550
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008551
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010085527.8. Pattern extraction
8553-----------------------
8554
8555The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8556response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8557for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8558
8559All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8560"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8561begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8562arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8563much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8564equivalent used in ACLs.
8565
8566The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8567
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008568 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8569 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8570 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8571 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8572 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8573 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8574 requested objects by host/path.
8575
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008576 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008577 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8578 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8579 according to RFC 4291.
8580
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008581 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8582 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8583 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008584 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8585 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8586 according to RFC 4291.
8587
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008588 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8589 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8590 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8591 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8592 type integer and only works with such tables.
8593
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008594 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8595 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8596 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8597 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8598 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8599 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8600 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008601 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008602
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008603 is_ssl This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8604 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer,
8605 otherwise zero.
8606
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008607 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8608 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8609 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8610 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8611 wiser to use "url" instead.
8612
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008613 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008614 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8615 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8616 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8617 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008618
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008619 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008620 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8621 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8622 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8623 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8624 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8625 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8626 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8627 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008628
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008629 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8630 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8631 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8632 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8633
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008634 ssl_has_sni This checks the data layer used by incoming connection, and
8635 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS data layer
8636 and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
8637 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
8638 support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8639
8640 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
8641 connection made via an SSL/TLS data layer and locally deciphered
8642 by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching the HTTPS
8643 host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have been
8644 built with support for TLS extensions (check haproxy -vv).
8645
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008646 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8647 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8648 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8649 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8650
8651 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8652 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8653 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8654 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8655 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8656 table for a given source address.
8657
8658 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8659 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8660
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008661 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008662 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8663 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8664 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8665 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8666 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008667
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008668 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008669 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8670 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8671 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8672 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008673
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008674 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8675 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8676 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8677 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8678 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8679 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8680 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008681
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008682 Example :
8683 listen tse-farm
8684 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8685 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8686 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8687 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8688 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8689 persist rdp-cookie
8690 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8691 # This is only useful makes sense if
8692 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8693 stick-table type string size 204800
8694 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8695 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8696 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008697
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008698 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8699 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008700
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008701 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008702 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008703 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8704 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8705 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8706 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8707 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8708 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008709
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008710 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008711
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008712 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008713 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8714 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8715 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8716
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008717 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8718 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8719 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8720 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8721 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008722
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008723 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008724
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008725
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008726The currently available list of transformations include :
8727
8728 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8729 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8730 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8731
8732 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8733 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8734 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8735
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008736 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008737 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8738 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8739 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8740 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8741
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087438. Logging
8744----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008745
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008746One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8747provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8748very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8749provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8750state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008751to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008752headers.
8753
8754In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8755about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8756send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8757
8758 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8759 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8760 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8761 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8762 at the termination.
8763
8764The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8765allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8766as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8767while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8768real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8769delay.
8770
8771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087728.1. Log levels
8773---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008774
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008775TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008776source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008777HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8778in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8779track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8780syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8781about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008782
8783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087848.2. Log formats
8785----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008786
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008787HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008788and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8789slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8790options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008791
8792 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8793 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8794 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8795 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8796 extents.
8797
8798 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8799 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8800 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8801 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8802 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8803
8804 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8805 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8806 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8807 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8808 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8809
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008810 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8811 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8812 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8813 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8814
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008815 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8816
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008817Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8818specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8819field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8820servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8821always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8822identifier.
8823
8824Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8825 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8826 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8827 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8828 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8829
8830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088318.2.1. Default log format
8832-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008833
8834This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8835as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8836format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8837
8838 Example :
8839 listen www
8840 mode http
8841 log global
8842 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8843
8844 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8845 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8846 (www/HTTP)
8847
8848 Field Format Extract from the example above
8849 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8850 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8851 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8852 4 'to' to
8853 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8854 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8855
8856Detailed fields description :
8857 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8858 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8859 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8860 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8861 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8862 and processed the connection.
8863 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8864
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008865In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8866"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8867connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8868
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008869It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8870will eventually disappear.
8871
8872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088738.2.2. TCP log format
8874---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008875
8876The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8877is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8878information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8879counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8880emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8881environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8882the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8883sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008884specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8885not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8886fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8887marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008888
8889 Example :
8890 frontend fnt
8891 mode tcp
8892 option tcplog
8893 log global
8894 default_backend bck
8895
8896 backend bck
8897 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8898
8899 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8900 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8901 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8902
8903 Field Format Extract from the example above
8904 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8905 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8906 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8907 4 frontend_name fnt
8908 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8909 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8910 7 bytes_read* 212
8911 8 termination_state --
8912 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8913 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8914
8915Detailed fields description :
8916 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008917 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8918 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8919 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8920 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8921 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008922
8923 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008924 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8925 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8926 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008927
8928 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8929 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8930 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8931 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8932
8933 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8934 and processed the connection.
8935
8936 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8937 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8938 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8939 applications.
8940
8941 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8942 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8943 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8944 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8945 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8946
8947 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8948 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8949 See "Timers" below for more details.
8950
8951 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8952 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8953 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8954 "Timers" below for more details.
8955
8956 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8957 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8958 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8959 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8960 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8961 details.
8962
8963 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8964 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8965 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8966 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8967 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8968
8969 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8970 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8971 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8972 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8973 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8974 for more details.
8975
8976 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008977 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008978 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8979 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8980 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008981 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008982
8983 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8984 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8985 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8986 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8987 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8988 caused by a denial of service attack.
8989
8990 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8991 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8992 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8993 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8994 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8995 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8996 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8997 denial of service attack.
8998
8999 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9000 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9001 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9002 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9003 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9004 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9005 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9006 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9007 be processed than on other servers.
9008
9009 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9010 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9011 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9012 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9013 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9014 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9015 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9016 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9017 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9018 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9019 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9020 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9021 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9022
9023 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9024 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9025 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9026 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9027 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9028 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9029 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9030 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9031
9032 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9033 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9034 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9035 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9036 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9037 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9038 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9039 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9040 occurs.
9041
9042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090438.2.3. HTTP log format
9044----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009045
9046The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9047is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9048the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9049are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9050emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9051generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9052"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9053which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009054frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9055is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009056
9057Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9058slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9059with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9060
9061 Example :
9062 frontend http-in
9063 mode http
9064 option httplog
9065 log global
9066 default_backend bck
9067
9068 backend static
9069 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9070
9071 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9072 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9073 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009074 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009075
9076 Field Format Extract from the example above
9077 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9078 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9079 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9080 4 frontend_name http-in
9081 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9082 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9083 7 status_code 200
9084 8 bytes_read* 2750
9085 9 captured_request_cookie -
9086 10 captured_response_cookie -
9087 11 termination_state ----
9088 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9089 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9090 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9091 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9092 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009093
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009094
9095Detailed fields description :
9096 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009097 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9098 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9099 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9100 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9101 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009102
9103 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009104 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9105 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9106 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009107
9108 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9109 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9110 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9111 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9112 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9113
9114 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9115 and processed the connection.
9116
9117 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9118 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9119 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9120
9121 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9122 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9123 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9124 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9125 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9126 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9127
9128 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9129 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9130 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9131 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9132 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9133 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9134
9135 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9136 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9137 See "Timers" below for more details.
9138
9139 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9140 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9141 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9142 below for more details.
9143
9144 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9145 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9146 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9147 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9148 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9149 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9150 for more details.
9151
9152 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9153 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9154 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9155 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9156 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9157 details.
9158
9159 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9160 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9161 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9162
9163 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9164 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9165 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9166 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9167 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9168 overflowing.
9169
9170 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9171 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9172 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9173 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9174 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9175 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9176 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9177 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9178
9179 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9180 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9181 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9182 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9183 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9184 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9185 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9186 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9187
9188 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9189 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9190 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9191 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9192 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9193 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9194 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9195
9196 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009197 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009198 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9199 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9200 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009201 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009202 system.
9203
9204 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9205 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9206 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9207 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9208 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9209 caused by a denial of service attack.
9210
9211 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9212 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9213 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9214 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9215 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9216 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9217 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9218 denial of service attack.
9219
9220 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9221 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9222 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9223 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9224 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9225 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9226 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9227 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9228 processed than on other servers.
9229
9230 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9231 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9232 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9233 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9234 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9235 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9236 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9237 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9238 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9239 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9240 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9241 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9242 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9243
9244 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9245 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9246 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9247 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9248 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9249 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9250 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9251 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9252
9253 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9254 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9255 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9256 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9257 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9258 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9259 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9260 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9261 occurs.
9262
9263 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9264 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9265 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9266 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9267 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9268 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9269 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9270 cookies" below for more details.
9271
9272 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9273 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9274 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9275 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9276 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9277 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9278 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9279 and cookies" below for more details.
9280
9281 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9282 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9283 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9284 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9285 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9286 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9287 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9288 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9289
9290
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020092918.2.4. Custom log format
9292------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009293
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009294The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9295mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009296
9297HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9298Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9299separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9300prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9301
9302Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9303variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9304string formats ("Q").
9305
9306Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9307HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9308
9309Flags are :
9310 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009311 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009312
9313 Example:
9314
9315 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9316 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9317
9318At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9319
9320 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009321 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009322
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009323the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009324
9325 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009326 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009327 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9328
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009329and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9330
9331 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9332 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9333
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009334Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9335
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009336 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9337 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9338 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9339 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9340 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9341 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009342 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009343 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009344 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009345 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009346 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9347 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9348 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009349 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009350 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9351 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9352 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009353 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9354 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9355 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009356 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009357 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9358 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9359 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9360 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9361 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9362 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9363 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009364 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009365 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9366 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9367 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9368 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9369 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9370 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9371 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9372 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009373 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009374 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9375 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9376 | | %s | server_name | string |
9377 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9378 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9379 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009380 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009381 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009382 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009383 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009384
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009385*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093878.3. Advanced logging options
9388-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009389
9390Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9391just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9392options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9393for more information about their usage.
9394
9395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9397------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009398
9399It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9400haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9401commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9402monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9403ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9404
9405 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9406 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9407 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9408 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9409
9410 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9411 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9412 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9413 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9414 such as other load-balancers.
9415
9416 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9417 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9418 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9419
9420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094218.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9422----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009423
9424The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9425what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9426or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9427"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9428just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9429log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9430after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9431is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9432with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9433with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9434
9435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094368.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9437------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009438
9439Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9440for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9441"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9442retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9443raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9444a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9445file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9446you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9447"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9448
9449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094508.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9451--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009452
9453Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9454multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9455them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9456"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9457logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9458error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9459and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9460too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9461useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9462alternative.
9463
9464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094658.4. Timing events
9466------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009467
9468Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9469reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9470the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9471frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9472mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9473
9474 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9475 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9476 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9477 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9478 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9479
9480 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9481 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9482 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9483 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9484 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9485
9486 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9487 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9488 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9489 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9490 connection never established.
9491
9492 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9493 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9494 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9495 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9496 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9497 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9498 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9499 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9500 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9501 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9502 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9503
9504 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9505 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9506 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9507 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9508 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9509
9510 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9511
9512 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9513 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9514 negative.
9515
9516These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9517protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9518that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009519due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009520close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9521session has been aborted on timeout.
9522
9523Most common cases :
9524
9525 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9526 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9527 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9528 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9529 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9530 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9531 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9532 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9533 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009534 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9535 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9536 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009537
9538 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9539 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9540 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9541 of ms on remote networks.
9542
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009543 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9544 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9545 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009546
9547 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9548 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9549 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9550 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9551 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9552 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9553 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9554 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9555 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9556 to the server until another one is released.
9557
9558Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9559
9560 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9561 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9562 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9563
9564 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9565 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9566 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9567
9568 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9569 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9570 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9571 flags.
9572
9573 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9574 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9575 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9576 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9577 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9578 the client connection was maintained open.
9579
9580 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9581 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9582 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9583 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9584
9585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095868.5. Session state at disconnection
9587-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009588
9589TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9590"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
95912-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9592each of which has a special meaning :
9593
9594 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9595 session to terminate :
9596
9597 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9598
9599 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9600 server explicitly refused it.
9601
9602 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9603 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9604 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9605 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9606 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9607 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9608
9609 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9610 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9611 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9612 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9613 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9614
9615 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9616 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9617 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9618 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9619 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9620
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009621 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9622 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9623
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009624 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9625 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9626 backup connections when going up.
9627
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009628 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9629
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009630 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9631 send or receive data.
9632
9633 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9634 send or receive data.
9635
9636 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9637 with nothing left in the buffers.
9638
9639 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9640
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009641 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009642 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9643
9644 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9645 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9646 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9647 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9648 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9649
9650 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9651 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9652
9653 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9654 server (HTTP only).
9655
9656 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9657
9658 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9659 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9660 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9661
9662 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9663 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9664 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9665
9666 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9667
9668 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9669 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9670
9671 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9672 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9673 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9674
9675 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9676 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009677 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9678 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009679
9680 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9681 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9682 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9683 another server.
9684
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009685 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009686 server.
9687
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009688 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9689 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9690 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9691 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9692
9693 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9694 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9695 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9696 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9697
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009698 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9699 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9700 "use-server" rule).
9701
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009702 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9703
9704 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9705 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9706
9707 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9708
9709 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9710 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9711 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9712
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009713 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9714 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9715 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9716 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9717 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9718
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009719 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9720
9721 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9722 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9723
9724 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9725
9726 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9727
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009728The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9729was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009730helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9731starvation, attacks, etc...
9732
9733The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9734alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9735easier finding and understanding.
9736
9737 Flags Reason
9738
9739 -- Normal termination.
9740
9741 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9742 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9743 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9744 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9745
9746 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9747 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9748 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9749 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9750 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9751 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009752
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009753 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9754 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009755 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009756
9757 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9758 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9759 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9760
9761 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9762 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9763 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9764 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9765 the server takes too long to respond.
9766
9767 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9768 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9769 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9770 long a time to respond.
9771
9772 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9773 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9774 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9775 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9776 and the client.
9777
9778 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9779 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9780 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9781 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9782 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9783 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9784
9785 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9786 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009787 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9788 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9789 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9790 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009792 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009793 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9794 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9795 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9796 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9797 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9798
9799 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9800 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9801 503 or 504 here.
9802
9803 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9804 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9805 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9806 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9807 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9808
9809 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9810 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009811 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009812 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9813 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9814
9815 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9816 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9817 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9818 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9819 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9820 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9821 between haproxy and the server.
9822
9823 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9824 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9825 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9826 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9827 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9828 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9829 solution is to fix the application.
9830
9831 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9832 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9833 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9834 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9835 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9836 external attacks.
9837
9838 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9839 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009840 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009841 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9842 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9843
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009844 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9845 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9846 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9847 the client.
9848
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009849 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9850 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9851 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9852 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009853 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9854 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9855 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9856 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9857 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009858
9859 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9860 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9861 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9862 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9863
9864 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9865 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9866 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9867 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9868
9869 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9870 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9871 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9872 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9873
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009874The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9875persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9876important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9877re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9878
9879 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9880
9881 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9882 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9883 set on a GET request.
9884
9885 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9886 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009887 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009888 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9889
9890 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9891 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9892 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9893
9894 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9895 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9896 already got a cookie.
9897
9898 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9899 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9900 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9901 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9902 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9903
9904 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9905 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9906 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9907
9908 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9909 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9910 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9911
9912 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9913 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9914
9915 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9916 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9917 then advertised in the response.
9918
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099208.6. Non-printable characters
9921-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009922
9923In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9924consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9925converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9926prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9927being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9928escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9929is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9930'}' when logging headers.
9931
9932Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9933issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9934containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9935
9936Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9937the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9938performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9939
9940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099418.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9942---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009943
9944Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9945achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009946section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009947cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9948the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9949the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009950locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009951not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9952user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9953a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9954wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9955
9956 Examples :
9957 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9958 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9959
9960 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9961 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9962
9963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099648.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9965---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009966
9967Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9968proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9969the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9970server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9971
9972Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9973response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009974section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009975
9976It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009977time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9978appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009979are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9980and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9981follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9982request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9983in the logs.
9984
9985 Example :
9986 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9987 listen proxy-out
9988 mode http
9989 option httplog
9990 option logasap
9991 log global
9992 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9993
9994 # log the name of the virtual server
9995 capture request header Host len 20
9996
9997 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9998 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9999
10000 # log the beginning of the referrer
10001 capture request header Referer len 20
10002
10003 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10004 capture response header Server len 20
10005
10006 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10007 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10008
10009 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10010 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10011
10012 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10013 capture response header Via len 20
10014
10015 # log the URL location during a redirection
10016 capture response header Location len 20
10017
10018 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10019 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10020 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10021 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10022 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10023
10024 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10025 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10026 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10027 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010028 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010029
10030 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10031 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10032 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10033 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10034 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010035 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010036
10037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100388.9. Examples of logs
10039---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010040
10041These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10042them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10043reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10044
10045 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10046 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10047 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10048
10049 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10050 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10051
10052 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10053 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10054 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10055
10056 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10057 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10058
10059 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10060 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10061 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10062
10063 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010064 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010065 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10066 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10067
10068 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10069 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10070 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10071
10072 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10073 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010074 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010075 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10076 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10077 to return the 502 and not the server.
10078
10079 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010080 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010081
10082 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10083 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10084 Nothing was sent to any server.
10085
10086 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10087 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10088
10089 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10090 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10091 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10092 send a 408 return code to the client.
10093
10094 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10095 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10096
10097 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10098 5 seconds ("c----").
10099
10100 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10101 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010102 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010103
10104 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010105 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010106 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10107 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10108 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10109 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10110 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010111
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101139. Statistics and monitoring
10114----------------------------
10115
10116It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10117mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10118CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10119Unix socket.
10120
10121
101229.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010123---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010124
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010125The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10126page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010128 0. pxname: proxy name
10129 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10130 for server)
10131 2. qcur: current queued requests
10132 3. qmax: max queued requests
10133 4. scur: current sessions
10134 5. smax: max sessions
10135 6. slim: sessions limit
10136 7. stot: total sessions
10137 8. bin: bytes in
10138 9. bout: bytes out
10139 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010140 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010141 12. ereq: request errors
10142 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010143 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010144 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10145 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010146 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010147 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10148 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10149 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10150 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10151 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10152 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10153 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10154 25. qlimit: queue limit
10155 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10156 27. iid: unique proxy id
10157 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10158 29. throttle: warm up status
10159 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10160 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010161 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010162 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10163 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10164 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010165 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010166 UNK -> unknown
10167 INI -> initializing
10168 SOCKERR -> socket error
10169 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10170 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10171 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10172 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10173 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10174 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10175 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10176 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10177 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10178 disable-on-404
10179 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10180 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10181 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010182 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10183 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010184 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10185 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10186 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10187 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10188 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10189 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010190 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10191 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10192 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10193 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010194 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10195 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010196
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101989.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010199-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010200
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010201The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010202must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10203is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10204a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10205risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10206followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10207given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10208then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10209to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010210
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010211It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10212on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10213own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010214
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010215clear counters
10216 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10217 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10218 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10219 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10220 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10221
10222clear counters all
10223 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10224 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10225 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10226
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010227clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10228 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10229
10230 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10231 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10232 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10233 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10234 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10235 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10236
10237 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10238
10239 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10240 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10241 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10242 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10243 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10244 the ACLs :
10245
10246 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10247 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10248 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10249 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10250 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10251 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10252
10253 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010254 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10255 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010256
10257 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010258 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010259 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010260 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10261 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10262 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10263 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010264
10265 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10266
10267 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010268 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010269 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10270 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010271 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10272 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10273 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010274
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010275disable frontend <frontend>
10276 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10277 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10278 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10279 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10280 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10281 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10282 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10283 on the stats page.
10284
10285 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10286 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10287
10288 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10289 level "admin".
10290
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010291disable server <backend>/<server>
10292 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10293 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10294 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10295 during the maintenance.
10296
10297 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10298 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10299
10300 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010301 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010302
10303 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10304 level "admin".
10305
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010306enable frontend <frontend>
10307 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10308 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10309 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10310 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10311 which was disabled.
10312
10313 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10314 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10315
10316 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10317 level "admin".
10318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010319enable server <backend>/<server>
10320 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10321 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10322
10323 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010324 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010325
10326 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10327 level "admin".
10328
10329get weight <backend>/<server>
10330 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10331 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10332 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10333 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10334 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010335 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010336
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010337help
10338 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10339 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010340
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010341prompt
10342 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10343 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10344 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10345 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10346 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10347 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10348 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10349 command.
10350
10351quit
10352 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010353
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010354set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10355 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10356 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10357 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10358 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10359 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10360 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10361 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10362
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010363set maxconn global <maxconn>
10364 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10365 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10366 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10367 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10368 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10369 setting.
10370
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010371set rate-limit connections global <value>
10372 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10373 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10374 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10375 is passed in number of connections per second.
10376
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010377set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10378 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10379 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10380 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10381 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10382 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10383
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010384set timeout cli <delay>
10385 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10386 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10387 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10388
10389set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10390 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10391 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10392 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10393 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10394 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10395 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10396 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10397 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10398 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10399 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10400 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10401 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10402 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010403 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010404
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010405show errors [<iid>]
10406 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10407 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010408 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10409 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10410 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010411
10412 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10413 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10414 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10415 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10416 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10417 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10418 are reported too.
10419
10420 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10421 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10422 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10423 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10424 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10425 code.
10426
10427 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10428 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10429 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10430 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10431 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10432 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10433 line.
10434
10435 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010436 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10437 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010438 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10439 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10440
10441 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10442 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10443 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10444 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10445 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10446 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10447 00204+ minal\r\n
10448 00211 \r\n
10449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010450 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010451 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10452 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10453 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10454 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10455 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10456 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010457
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010458show info
10459 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10460
10461show sess
10462 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010463 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10464 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10465
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010466show sess <id>
10467 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10468 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10469 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10470 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10471 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10472 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010473
10474show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10475 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10476 possible to dump only selected items :
10477 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10478 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10479 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10480 for example:
10481 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10482 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10483 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10484
10485 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010486 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10487 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010488 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10489 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10490 Nbproc: 1
10491 Process_num: 1
10492 (...)
10493
10494 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10495 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10496 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10497 (...)
10498 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10499
10500 $
10501
10502 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10503 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10504 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10505 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010506 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010507
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010508show table
10509 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10510 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10511 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10512 entries currently in use.
10513
10514 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010515 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010516 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10517 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010518
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010519show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010520 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10521 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10522 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010523 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10524
10525 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10526 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10527 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10528 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10529 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10530
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010531 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10532 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10533 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10534 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10535 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10536 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10537
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010538
10539 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010540 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10541 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010542
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010543 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010544 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010545 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010546 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10547 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10548 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10549 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010550
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010551 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010552 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010553 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10554 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010555
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010556 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10557 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010558 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010559 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10560 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010561
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010562 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10563 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010564 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010565 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10566 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10567
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010568 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10569 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10570 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10571 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10572 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10573
10574 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10575 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10576 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010577 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10578 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010579 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10580 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010581
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010582shutdown frontend <frontend>
10583 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10584 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10585 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10586 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10587 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10588 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10589 once it is terminated.
10590
10591 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10592 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10593
10594 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10595 level "admin".
10596
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010597shutdown session <id>
10598 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10599 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10600 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10601 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10602 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10603 flag in the logs.
10604
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010605shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10606 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10607 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10608 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10609 'K' flag in the logs.
10610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010611/*
10612 * Local variables:
10613 * fill-column: 79
10614 * End:
10615 */